blob: 83fb85a56788e9897aa2186088df1790900f5d06 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau33205c22020-07-07 16:35:28 +02005 version 2.3
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreauf104b532020-08-14 18:54:05 +02007 2020/08/14
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020057
584. Proxies
594.1. Proxy keywords matrix
604.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
61
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100625. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200635.1. Bind options
645.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200655.3. Server DNS resolution
665.3.1. Global overview
675.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020068
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100696. Cache
706.1. Limitation
716.2. Setup
726.2.1. Cache section
736.2.2. Proxy section
74
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200757. Using ACLs and fetching samples
767.1. ACL basics
777.1.1. Matching booleans
787.1.2. Matching integers
797.1.3. Matching strings
807.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
817.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
827.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
837.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
847.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200857.3.1. Converters
867.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
877.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
887.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
897.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
907.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200917.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200927.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093
948. Logging
958.1. Log levels
968.2. Log formats
978.2.1. Default log format
988.2.2. TCP log format
998.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001008.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001018.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001028.3. Advanced logging options
1038.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1048.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1058.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1068.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1078.4. Timing events
1088.5. Session state at disconnection
1098.6. Non-printable characters
1108.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1118.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1128.9. Examples of logs
113
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001149. Supported filters
1159.1. Trace
1169.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001179.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001189.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001199.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200120
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012110. FastCGI applications
12210.1. Setup
12310.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12410.1.2. Proxy section
12510.1.3. Example
12610.2. Default parameters
12710.3. Limitations
128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129
1301. Quick reminder about HTTP
131----------------------------
132
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
135on almost anything found in the contents.
136
137However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
138formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
139correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
140
141
1421.1. The HTTP transaction model
143-------------------------------
144
145The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100146to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100147from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
148connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149will involve a new connection :
150
151 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
152
153In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
154establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
155by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
156length.
157
158Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
159to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
160however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
161response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
162header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
167power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
168but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100171Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
173second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
174page :
175
176 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
177
178This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
179latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
180correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
181the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100182server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100184The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
185time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
186are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
187parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
188carry the stream identifier.
189
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
191connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
192leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100193start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
194processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
195waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200196
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200197HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
199 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100200 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100201 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200202 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100203
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100204
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205
2061.2. HTTP request
207-----------------
208
209First, let's consider this HTTP request :
210
211 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100212 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
214 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
215 3 User-agent: my small browser
216 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
217 5 Accept: image/png
218
219
2201.2.1. The Request line
221-----------------------
222
223Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
224
225 - a METHOD : GET
226 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
227 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
228
229All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
230which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
231followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
232is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
233desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
234the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
235
236The URI itself can have several forms :
237
238 - A "relative URI" :
239
240 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
243 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
244
245 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
246
247 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
250 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
251 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
252 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
253 must accept this form too.
254
255 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
256 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
257 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100258
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200259 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
260 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
261 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
262 other protocols too.
263
264In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
265mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
266on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
267It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
268specific to the language, framework or application in use.
269
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100270HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100271assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200273
2741.2.2. The request headers
275--------------------------
276
277The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
278beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
279an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
280Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
281values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
282encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
283the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
284define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
285
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100286Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100288"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200289as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
290normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
291representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
292HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200293
294The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
295that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
296is one valid form of empty line.
297
298Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
299headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
300about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
301application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
302
303Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000304 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200305 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
306 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
307 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
308
309
3101.3. HTTP response
311------------------
312
313An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
314messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
315
316 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100317 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200318 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
319 2 Content-length: 350
320 3 Content-Type: text/html
321
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200322As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
323codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
324response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100325continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
326the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
327following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
328sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
329(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
330correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
331such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
332state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
333over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
334if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
335information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200336
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200337
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003381.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200339------------------------
340
341Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
342
343 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
344 - a status code : 200
345 - a reason : OK
346
347The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100348 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
349 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
350 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
351 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
352 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200353
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000354Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100355"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
357messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
358or "Authentication Required".
359
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100360HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361
362 Code When / reason
363 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
364 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
365 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
366 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100367 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
368 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200369 400 for an invalid or too large request
370 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
371 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200372 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100373 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200374 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100375 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
376 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
378 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
379 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200380 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
382 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
383 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
384
385The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3864.2).
387
388
3891.3.2. The response headers
390---------------------------
391
392Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
393the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
394details.
395
396
3972. Configuring HAProxy
398----------------------
399
4002.1. Configuration file format
401------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200402
403HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
404
405 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
406 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
407 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
408 "frontend" and "backend".
409
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100410The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
411referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100413
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200414
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004152.2. Quoting and escaping
416-------------------------
417
418HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
419many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
420with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
421single quotes.
422
423If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
424them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
425escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
426
427Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
428
429 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
430 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
431 \\ to use a backslash
432 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
433 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
434
435Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
436the interpretation of:
437
438 space as a parameter separator
439 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
440 # hash as a comment start
441
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200442Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
443-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
444backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
445
446Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200447quoting.
448
449Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
450nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
451
452Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
453equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
454
455 Example:
456 # those are equivalents:
457 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
458 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
459 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
460 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
461 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
462
463 # those are equivalents:
464 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
465 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
466 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
467 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
468
469
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004702.3. Environment variables
471--------------------------
472
473HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
474interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
475configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
476optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
477shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
478underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
479
480 Example:
481
482 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
483
484 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
485
486 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
487
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200488Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
489file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200490
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200491* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
492 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
493
494* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
495 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
496 directory.
497
498* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
499
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500500* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200501 processes, separated by semicolons.
502
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500503* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200504 CLI, separated by semicolons.
505
506See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200507
5082.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200509----------------
510
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100511Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100512values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
513otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
514numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
515for every keyword. Supported units are :
516
517 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
518 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
519 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
520 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
521 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
522 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
523
524
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005252.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200526-------------
527
528 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
529 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
530 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
531 global
532 daemon
533 maxconn 256
534
535 defaults
536 mode http
537 timeout connect 5000ms
538 timeout client 50000ms
539 timeout server 50000ms
540
541 frontend http-in
542 bind *:80
543 default_backend servers
544
545 backend servers
546 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
547
548
549 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
550 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
551 global
552 daemon
553 maxconn 256
554
555 defaults
556 mode http
557 timeout connect 5000ms
558 timeout client 50000ms
559 timeout server 50000ms
560
561 listen http-in
562 bind *:80
563 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
564
565
566Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
567
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100568 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200569
570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005713. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200572--------------------
573
574Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
575are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
576of them have command-line equivalents.
577
578The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
579
580 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200581 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200582 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200583 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200584 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200585 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200586 - description
587 - deviceatlas-json-file
588 - deviceatlas-log-level
589 - deviceatlas-separator
590 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900591 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200592 - gid
593 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100594 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200595 - h1-case-adjust
596 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100597 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100598 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100599 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200600 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200601 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200602 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100603 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200604 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100605 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200606 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200607 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200608 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200609 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200610 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200611 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100612 - presetenv
613 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200614 - uid
615 - ulimit-n
616 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200617 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100618 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200619 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200620 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200621 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200622 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200623 - ssl-default-bind-options
624 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200625 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200626 - ssl-default-server-options
627 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100628 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200629 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100630 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100631 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100632 - 51degrees-data-file
633 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200634 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200635 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200636 - wurfl-data-file
637 - wurfl-information-list
638 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200639 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100640 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100641
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200642 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100643 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200644 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200646 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100647 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100648 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100649 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200650 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200651 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200652 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200653 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200654 - noepoll
655 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000656 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200657 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100658 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300659 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000660 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100661 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200662 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200663 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200664 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000665 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000666 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200667 - tune.buffers.limit
668 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200669 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200670 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100671 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200672 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200673 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200674 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200675 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100676 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200677 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200678 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +0200679 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100680 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100681 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100682 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100683 - tune.lua.session-timeout
684 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200685 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100686 - tune.maxaccept
687 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200688 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200689 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200690 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +0200691 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
692 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100693 - tune.rcvbuf.client
694 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100695 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200696 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +0200697 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100698 - tune.sndbuf.client
699 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100700 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +0200701 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100702 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200703 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100704 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200705 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200706 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100707 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200708 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100709 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200710 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
711 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
712 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100713 - tune.zlib.memlevel
714 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100715
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200716 * Debugging
717 - debug
718 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200719 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200720
721
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007223.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200723------------------------------------
724
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200725ca-base <dir>
726 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100727 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
728 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
729 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200730
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200731chroot <jail dir>
732 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
733 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
734 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
735 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
736 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100737 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100738
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100739cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
740 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
741 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
742 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
743 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
744 set. These sets have the format
745
746 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
747
748 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100749 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100750 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
751 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100752 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
753 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100754 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100755 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100756 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100757 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100758 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
759 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
760 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
761 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100762
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100763 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
764 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
765 on the machine's word size.
766
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100767 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100768 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
769 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
770 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
771 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
772 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
773 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100774
775 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100776 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
777
778 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
779 # first 4 CPUs
780
781 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
782 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
783 # word size.
784
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100785 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100786 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100787 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
788 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
789 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
790
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100791 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
792 # and so on.
793 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
794 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
795 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
796
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100797 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100798 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
799 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
800 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
801
802 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
803 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
804 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
805
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100806 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
807 # and a thread range.
808 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
809 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
810 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
811
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200812crt-base <dir>
813 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100814 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
815 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200816
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200817daemon
818 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
819 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100820 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
821 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200822
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200823deviceatlas-json-file <path>
824 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100825 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200826
827deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100828 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200829 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
830
831deviceatlas-separator <char>
832 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
833 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
834
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100835deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200836 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
837 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
838 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100839
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900840external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100841 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
842 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100843 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
844 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
845 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
846 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
847 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900848
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200849gid <number>
850 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
851 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
852 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100853 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
854 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200855 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100856
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100857group <group name>
858 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
859 See also "gid" and "user".
860
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100861hard-stop-after <time>
862 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
863
864 Arguments :
865 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
866 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
867 SIGUSR1 signal.
868
869 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
870 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
871 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
872
873 Example:
874 global
875 hard-stop-after 30s
876
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200877h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
878 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
879 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
880 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
881 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500882 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200883 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
884 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
885 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
886 specified in a proxy.
887
888 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
889 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
890 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
891 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
892 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
893 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
894 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
895
896 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
897 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
898 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
899 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
900 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
901
902 Example:
903 global
904 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
905
906 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
907 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
908
909h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
910 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
911 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
912 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
913 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
914 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
915 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
916 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
917 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
918
919 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
920 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
921 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
922
923 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
924 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
925
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100926insecure-fork-wanted
927 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
928 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
929 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
930 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
931 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
932 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
933 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
934 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
935 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
936 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
937 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
938 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
939 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
940 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
941 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
942 disable it.
943
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100944insecure-setuid-wanted
945 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
946 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
947 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
948 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
949 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
950 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
951 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
952 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
953 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
954 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
955 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
956 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
957 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
958 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
959
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100960issuers-chain-path <dir>
961 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
962 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
963 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
964 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
965 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
966 "issuers-chain-path".
967 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
968 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
969 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
970 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
971 will share the chain in memory.
972
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200973localpeer <name>
974 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
975 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
976 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
977 the configuration parsing.
978
979 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
980 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
981
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200982log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
983 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100984 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100985 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100986 configured with "log global".
987
988 <address> can be one of:
989
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100990 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100991 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
992 port).
993
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100994 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
995 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
996 port).
997
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100998 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100999 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1000 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001001 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001002
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001003 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1004 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1005 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1006 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1007 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1008 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1009 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1010 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1011 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1012 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1013 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1014 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1015 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1016 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001017 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1018 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001019
1020 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1021 "fd@2", see above.
1022
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001023 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1024 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1025 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1026 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1027 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1028
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001029 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1030 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001031
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001032 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1033 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1034 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1035 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1036 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1037 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1038 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1039 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1040 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1041 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001042 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1043 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001044
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001045 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1046 one of the following :
1047
1048 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1049 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1050
1051 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1052 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1053
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001054 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1055 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1056 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1057 designed to be used with a local log server.
1058
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001059 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1060 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1061 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1062 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1063 logger consumes.
1064
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001065 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1066 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1067 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1068 used with a local log server.
1069
1070 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1071 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1072 designed to be used with a local log server.
1073
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001074 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1075 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1076 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1077 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1078
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001079 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1080 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1081 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1082 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1083 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1084
1085 <sample_size>
1086 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1087 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1088 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1089 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1090 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1091
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001092 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001093
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001094 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1095 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1096 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1097
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001098 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1099 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1100 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1101 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001102
1103 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001104 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1105 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1106 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1107 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1108 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1109 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001110
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001111 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001112
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001113log-send-hostname [<string>]
1114 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1115 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1116 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1117 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1118 the logs.
1119
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001120log-tag <string>
1121 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1122 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1123 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001124 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001125
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001126lua-load <file>
1127 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1128 used multiple times.
1129
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001130lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1131 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1132 variable.
1133 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1134 to "path".
1135
1136 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1137 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1138 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1139 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1140 will be checked earlier.
1141
1142 As an example by specifying the following path:
1143
1144 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1145 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1146
1147 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1148 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1149 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1150 paths if that does not exist either.
1151
1152 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1153 documentation.
1154
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001155master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001156 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1157 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1158 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001159 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001160 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1161 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001162 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1163 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1164 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1165 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1166 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001167
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001168 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001169
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001170mworker-max-reloads <number>
1171 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001172 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001173 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1174 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1175 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1176
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001177nbproc <number>
1178 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1179 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1180 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001181 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1182 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001183 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1184 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001185
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001186nbthread <number>
1187 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001188 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1189 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1190 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1191 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1192 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001193 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1194 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1195 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1196 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1197 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1198 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1199 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001200
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001201pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001202 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1203 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1204 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1205 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001206
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001207pp2-never-send-local
1208 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1209 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1210 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1211 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1212 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1213 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1214 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1215 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1216 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1217 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1218 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1219
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001220presetenv <name> <value>
1221 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1222 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1223 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1224 and "unsetenv".
1225
1226resetenv [<name> ...]
1227 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1228 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1229 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1230 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1231 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1232 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1233 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1234 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1235
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001236stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001237 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1238 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1239 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1240 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1241 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1242 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001243 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001244 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1245 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1246 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1247 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001248
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001249server-state-base <directory>
1250 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001251 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1252 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001253
1254server-state-file <file>
1255 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1256 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1257 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1258 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1259 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1260 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1261 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1262 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001263 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1264 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001265
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001266setenv <name> <value>
1267 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1268 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1269 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1270 and "unsetenv".
1271
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001272set-dumpable
1273 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001274 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1275 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1276 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1277 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1278 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1279 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1280 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1281 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1282 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1283 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1284 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1285 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1286 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1287 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1288 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1289 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1290 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001291
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001292ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1293 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1294 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001295 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001296 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001297 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1298 information and recommendations see e.g.
1299 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1300 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1301 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1302 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001303
1304ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1305 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1306 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1307 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1308 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1309 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001310 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1311 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1312 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001313 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001314
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001315ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1316 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1317 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1318 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1319 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1320 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1321
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001322ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1323 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1324 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1325 keyword to see available options.
1326
1327 Example:
1328 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001329 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001330
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001331ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1332 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1333 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001334 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001335 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001336 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1337 information and recommendations see e.g.
1338 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1339 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1340 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1341 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1342 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001343
1344ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1345 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1346 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1347 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1348 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1349 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001350 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1351 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1352 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1353 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001354
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001355ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1356 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1357 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1358 keyword to see available options.
1359
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001360ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1361 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1362 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1363 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001364 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001365 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001366 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1367 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1368 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1369 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001370 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1371 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1372 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1373
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001374ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001375 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
1376 the loading of the SSL certificates.
1377
1378 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1379 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1380 optimize the startup time.
1381
1382 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1383 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1384 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1385
1386 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001387 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001388
1389 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
1390 will try to load a certificate bundle. This is done by looking for
1391 <basename>.rsa, .ecdsa and .dsa. In the case of directories, HAProxy will
1392 try to gather the files with the same basename in a multi-certificate bundle.
1393 The bundles were introduced with OpenSSL 1.0.2 and were the only way back
1394 then to load an ECDSA certificate and a RSA one, with the same SNI. Since
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001395 OpenSSL 1.1.1 it is not recommended anymore, you can specify both the ECDSA
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001396 and the RSA file on the bind line.
1397
1398 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1399
1400 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1401
1402 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1403 not provided in the PEM file.
1404
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001405 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1406 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1407
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001408 The default behavior is "all".
1409
1410 Example:
1411 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1412 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1413 ssl-load-extra-files none
1414
1415 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1416
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001417ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1418 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1419 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1420 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1421
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001422ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001423 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001424 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1425 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1426 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1427 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1428 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1429 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001430 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001431
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001432stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1433 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1434 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1435 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001436 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001437 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001438
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001439 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1440 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1441 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001442
1443stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1444 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1445 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001446 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001447
1448stats maxconn <connections>
1449 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1450 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1451
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001452uid <number>
1453 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1454 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1455 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1456 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1457
1458ulimit-n <number>
1459 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1460 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1461 option.
1462
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001463unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1464 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1465
1466 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1467 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1468 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1469 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1470 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1471 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1472 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1473 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1474 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1475 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1476
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001477unsetenv [<name> ...]
1478 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1479 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1480 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1481 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1482 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1483 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1484 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1485
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001486user <user name>
1487 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1488 See also "uid" and "group".
1489
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001490node <name>
1491 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1492
1493 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1494 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1495 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1496 traffic.
1497
1498description <text>
1499 Add a text that describes the instance.
1500
1501 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1502 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1503 "<" and ">" characters.
1504
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100150551degrees-data-file <file path>
1506 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001507 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001508
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001509 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001510 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1511
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000151251degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001513 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1514 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1515 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1516
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001517 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001518 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1519
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200152051degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001521 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1522 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1523
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001524 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1525 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1526
152751degrees-cache-size <number>
1528 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1529 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1530 By default, this cache is disabled.
1531
1532 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001533 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1534
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001535wurfl-data-file <file path>
1536 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1537 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1538
1539 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1540 with USE_WURFL=1.
1541
1542wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1543 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1544 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1545 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1546
1547 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1548
1549 Valid WURFL properties are:
1550 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1551
1552 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1553 device.
1554
1555 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1556 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1557
1558 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1559 particular web request.
1560
1561 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1562 used Libwurfl API version.
1563
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001564 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1565 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1566
1567 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1568 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1569
1570 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1571
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001572 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1573 with USE_WURFL=1.
1574
1575wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1576 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1577 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1578
1579 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1580 with USE_WURFL=1.
1581
1582wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1583 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1584 thus before the chroot.
1585
1586 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1587 with USE_WURFL=1.
1588
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001589wurfl-cache-size <size>
1590 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1591 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001592 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001593 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001594
1595 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1596 with USE_WURFL=1.
1597
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001598strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01001599 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
1600 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
1601 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
1602 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
1603 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001604
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016053.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001606-----------------------
1607
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001608busy-polling
1609 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1610 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1611 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1612 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1613 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1614 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1615 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1616 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1617 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1618 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1619 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1620 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1621 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1622 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1623 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1624 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1625 "poll" pollers.
1626
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001627 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1628 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1629 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1630
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001631max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1632 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1633 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1634 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1635 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1636 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1637 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1638 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1639 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1640
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001641maxconn <number>
1642 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1643 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1644 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001645 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1646 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1647 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1648 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001649 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1650 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1651 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1652 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1653 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1654 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001655
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001656maxconnrate <number>
1657 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1658 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1659 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1660 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1661 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1662 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1663 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1664 fairness.
1665
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001666maxcomprate <number>
1667 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001668 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001669 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1670 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1671 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001672 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001673 default value.
1674
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001675maxcompcpuusage <number>
1676 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1677 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1678 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1679 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1680 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1681 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1682 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1683 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1684
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001685maxpipes <number>
1686 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1687 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1688 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1689 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1690 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1691 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1692
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001693maxsessrate <number>
1694 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1695 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1696 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1697 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1698 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1699 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1700 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1701 fairness.
1702
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001703maxsslconn <number>
1704 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1705 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1706 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1707 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1708 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1709 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1710 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001711 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1712 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1713 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1714 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1715 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1716 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1717 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001718
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001719maxsslrate <number>
1720 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1721 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1722 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1723 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1724 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1725 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1726 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1727 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1728 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1729 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1730
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001731maxzlibmem <number>
1732 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1733 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1734 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001735 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1736 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1737 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1738
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001739noepoll
1740 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1741 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001742 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001743
1744nokqueue
1745 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1746 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1747 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1748
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001749noevports
1750 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1751 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1752 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1753 also "nopoll".
1754
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001755nopoll
1756 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1757 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001758 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001759 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1760 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001761
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001762nosplice
1763 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001764 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001765 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001766 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001767 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1768 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1769 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1770 "option splice-response".
1771
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001772nogetaddrinfo
1773 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1774 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1775
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001776noreuseport
1777 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1778 command line argument "-dR".
1779
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001780profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1781 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1782 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1783 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1784 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001785 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001786 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1787 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1788 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1789 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1790
1791 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1792 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1793 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1794 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1795 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001796 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1797 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1798 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1799 CLI.
1800
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001801spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001802 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1803 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1804 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1805 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1806 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1807 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001808
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001809ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001810 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001811 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001812 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1813 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1814 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1815 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1816 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001817 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1818 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001819 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1820 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1821 openssl configuration file uses:
1822 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1823
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001824ssl-mode-async
1825 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001826 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001827 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1828 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1829 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001830 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001831 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001832
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001833tune.buffers.limit <number>
1834 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1835 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1836 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1837 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1838 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001839 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001840 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1841 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1842 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1843 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1844 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1845 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1846 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1847 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1848 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1849
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001850tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1851 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1852 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1853 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1854 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1855
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001856tune.bufsize <number>
1857 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1858 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1859 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1860 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1861 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1862 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1863 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001864 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1865 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1866 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001867 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001868 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1869 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1870 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001871
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001872tune.chksize <number>
1873 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1874 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1875 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1876 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1877 checks whenever possible.
1878
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001879tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1880 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1881 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1882 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1883 this value. The default value is 1.
1884
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001885tune.fail-alloc
1886 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1887 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1888 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1889 gracefully.
1890
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001891tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
1892 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
1893 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
1894 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
1895 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
1896 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
1897
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001898tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1899 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1900 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1901 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1902 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1903 change it.
1904
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001905tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1906 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001907 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1908 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001909 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1910 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1911 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1912 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1913 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1914
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001915tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1916 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1917 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1918 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1919 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1920 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1921 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1922 recommended not to change this value.
1923
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001924tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1925 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1926 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1927 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1928 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1929 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1930 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1931 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1932
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001933tune.http.cookielen <number>
1934 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1935 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1936 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1937 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1938 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1939 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1940 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1941 to change this value.
1942
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001943tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001944 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1945 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001946 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001947 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001948 configuration directives too.
1949 The default value is 1024.
1950
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001951tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1952 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1953 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1954 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1955 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1956 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1957 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001958 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1959 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1960 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001961
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001962tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
1963 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
1964 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
1965 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
1966 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
1967 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
1968 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
1969 this option to "off". The default is on.
1970
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001971tune.idletimer <timeout>
1972 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1973 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1974 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1975 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1976 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1977 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001978 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001979 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001980 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1981
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001982tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1983 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1984 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1985 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1986 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1987 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1988 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1989 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1990 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1991 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1992
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001993tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1994 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001995 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001996 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1997 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001998 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001999 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2000 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2001
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002002tune.lua.maxmem
2003 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2004 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2005 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2006 memory.
2007
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002008tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2009 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002010 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2011 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002012 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002013
2014tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2015 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2016 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2017 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2018 check servers.
2019
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002020tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2021 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2022 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2023 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002024 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002025
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002026tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002027 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2028 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
2029 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
2030 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
2031 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
2032 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
2033 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
2034 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
2035 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
2036 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002037
2038tune.maxpollevents <number>
2039 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2040 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2041 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2042 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2043 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2044
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002045tune.maxrewrite <number>
2046 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2047 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2048 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2049 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2050 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2051 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2052 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2053 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2054 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2055 bufsize.
2056
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002057tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2058 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2059 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2060 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2061 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2062 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2063 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2064 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2065 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2066 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002067 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2068 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002069 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2070 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2071 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2072 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2073 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2074 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2075 setting this parameter to 0.
2076
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002077tune.pipesize <number>
2078 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2079 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2080 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2081 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2082 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2083 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2084
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002085tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2086 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2087 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2088 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2089 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2090 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2091 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002092 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002093
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002094tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2095 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2096 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2097 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2098 default is 20.
2099
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002100tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2101tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2102 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2103 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2104 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002105 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002106 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002107 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2108 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2109
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002110tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002111 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002112 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2113 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2114 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2115 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2116
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002117tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002118 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002119 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002120 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead. When
2121 experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2122 tune.sched.low-latency to limit the maximum latency to the lowest possible.
2123
2124tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2125 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2126 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2127 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2128 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2129 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2130 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2131 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2132 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2133 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002134
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002135tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2136tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2137 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2138 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2139 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002140 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002141 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002142 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2143 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2144 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2145 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2146 notifying haproxy again.
2147
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002148tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002149 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2150 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2151 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002152 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002153 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002154 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002155 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2156 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2157 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002158 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2159 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002160
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002161tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002162 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002163 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2164 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2165 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2166 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2167 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2168
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002169tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2170 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2171 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2172 performances. This is disabled by default.
2173
2174 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2175 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2176
2177 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2178
2179 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2180
2181 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2182
2183 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2184 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2185 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2186
2187 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2188 converted.
2189
2190 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2191 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2192 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2193 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2194 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2195 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2196 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002197 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2198 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002199
2200 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2201
2202 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2203 only need this line:
2204
2205 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2206
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002207tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2208 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002209 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002210 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2211 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2212 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2213 being used for too long.
2214
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002215tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2216 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2217 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2218 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2219 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2220 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2221 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2222 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2223 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2224 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2225 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002226 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002227 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002228
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002229tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2230 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2231 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2232 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2233 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002234 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002235 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2236 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002237 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2238 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002239
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002240tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2241 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2242 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2243 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2244 1000 entries.
2245
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002246tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2247 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2248 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2249 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2250
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002251tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002252tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002253tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2254tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2255tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002256 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2257 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2258 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2259 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2260 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2261 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2262 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2263 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002264
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002265 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2266 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2267 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2268 all available space is consumed.
2269 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2270 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2271 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002272
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002273tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2274 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002275 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002276 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002277 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002278 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2279
2280tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2281 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2282 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002283 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2284 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002285
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022863.3. Debugging
2287--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002288
Willy Tarreau1b857852020-02-25 11:27:22 +01002289debug (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002290 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2291 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2292 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2293 system startup.
2294
2295quiet
2296 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2297 line argument "-q".
2298
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002299zero-warning
2300 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2301 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2302 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2303 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2304 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2305 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2306
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002307
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010023083.4. Userlists
2309--------------
2310It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2311http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2312it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2313
2314userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002315 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002316 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2317
2318group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002319 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002320 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2321 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2322
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002323user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2324 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002325 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2326 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002327 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2328 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2329 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2330 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002331
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002332 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2333 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2334 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2335 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2336 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2337 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2338 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2339 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2340 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002341
2342 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002343 userlist L1
2344 group G1 users tiger,scott
2345 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002346
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002347 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2348 user scott insecure-password elgato
2349 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002350
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002351 userlist L2
2352 group G1
2353 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002354
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002355 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2356 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2357 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002358
2359 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002360
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002361
23623.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002363----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002364It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2365several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2366instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2367values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2368automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2369In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2370using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2371tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2372reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2373Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2374that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2375each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002376
2377peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002378 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002379 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2380
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002381bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2382 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2383 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2384
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002385disabled
2386 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2387 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2388 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2389
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002390default-bind [param*]
2391 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2392
2393default-server [param*]
2394 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2395
2396 Arguments:
2397 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2398 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2399 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2400 details.
2401
2402
2403 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2404
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002405enable
2406 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2407
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002408log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2409 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2410 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2411 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2412 more details.
2413
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002414peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002415 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2416 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002417 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2418 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2419 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2420 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2421 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002422
2423 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2424 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2425
2426 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002427 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2428 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2429 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002430
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002431 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2432 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002433
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002434 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2435 "server" keyword explanation below).
2436
2437server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002438 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002439 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2440 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2441 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2442 of this "peers" section).
2443 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2444
2445
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002446 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002447 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002448 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002449 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2450 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2451 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002452
2453 backend mybackend
2454 mode tcp
2455 balance roundrobin
2456 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2457 stick on src
2458
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002459 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2460 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002461
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002462 Example:
2463 peers mypeers
2464 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2465 default-server ssl verify none
2466 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2467 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002468
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002469
2470table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2471 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2472
2473 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2474 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002475 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002476 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2477 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2478 "stick-table" keyword).
2479
2480 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2481 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2482 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2483 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2484 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2485 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2486 of the stick-table name as follows:
2487
2488 peers mypeers
2489 peer A ...
2490 peer B ...
2491 table t1 ...
2492
2493 frontend fe1
2494 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2495
2496 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2497 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2498
2499 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2500 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2501 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2502 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2503 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2504 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2505 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2506
2507 peers mypeers
2508 peer A ...
2509 peer B ...
2510 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2511
2512 backend t1
2513 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2514
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002515 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002516 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2517 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2518
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090025193.6. Mailers
2520------------
2521It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2522If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2523in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2524
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002525mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002526 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2527 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2528
2529mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2530 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2531
2532 Example:
2533 mailers mymailers
2534 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2535 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2536
2537 backend mybackend
2538 mode tcp
2539 balance roundrobin
2540
2541 email-alert mailers mymailers
2542 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2543 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2544
2545 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2546 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2547
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002548timeout mail <time>
2549 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2550 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2551 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2552 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2553
2554 Example:
2555 mailers mymailers
2556 timeout mail 20s
2557 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002558
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020025593.7. Programs
2560-------------
2561In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2562master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2563managed the same way as the workers.
2564
2565During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2566sequence as a worker:
2567
2568 - the master is re-executed
2569 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2570 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2571 instance of the program
2572
2573During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2574
2575program <name>
2576 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2577 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2578 the management guide).
2579
2580command <command> [arguments*]
2581 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2582 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2583 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2584 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2585
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002586user <user name>
2587 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2588 See also "group".
2589
2590group <group name>
2591 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2592 See also "user".
2593
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002594option start-on-reload
2595no option start-on-reload
2596 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2597 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2598 program section.
2599
2600
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010026013.8. HTTP-errors
2602----------------
2603
2604It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2605imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2606several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2607
2608http-errors <name>
2609 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2610 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2611
2612errorfile <code> <file>
2613 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2614
2615 Arguments :
2616 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02002617 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
2618 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002619
2620 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2621 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2622 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2623 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2624 before any chroot is performed.
2625
2626 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2627
2628 Example:
2629 http-errors website-1
2630 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2631 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2632 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2633
2634 http-errors website-2
2635 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2636 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2637 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2638
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020026393.9. Rings
2640----------
2641
2642It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
2643servers or traces.
2644
2645ring <ringname>
2646 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
2647
2648description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002649 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002650 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
2651
2652format <format>
2653 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
2654
2655 Arguments:
2656 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
2657 one of the following :
2658
2659 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
2660 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
2661 designed to be used with a local log server.
2662
2663 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
2664 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2665 used in containers or during development, where the severity
2666 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
2667 is the default.
2668
2669 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
2670 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
2671
2672 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
2673 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
2674
2675 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2676 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
2677 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
2678 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
2679 logger consumes.
2680
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02002681 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
2682 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
2683 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
2684 with a local log server.
2685
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002686 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2687 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
2688 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2689 used with a local log server.
2690
2691maxlen <length>
2692 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
2693 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
2694 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
2695
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002696server <name> <address> [param*]
2697 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
2698 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
2699 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
2700 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
2701 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
2702 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
2703 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
2704 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
2705 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002706 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
2707 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002708
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002709size <size>
2710 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
2711 set to BUFSIZE.
2712
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002713timeout connect <timeout>
2714 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2715
2716 Arguments :
2717 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2718 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2719 as explained at the top of this document.
2720
2721timeout server <timeout>
2722 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
2723
2724 Arguments :
2725 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2726 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2727 as explained at the top of this document.
2728
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002729 Example:
2730 global
2731 log ring@myring local7
2732
2733 ring myring
2734 description "My local buffer"
2735 format rfc3164
2736 maxlen 1200
2737 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002738 timeout connect 5s
2739 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002740 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002741
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020027423.10. Log forwarding
2743-------------------
2744
2745It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
2746haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
2747
2748log-forward <name>
2749 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
2750
2751bind <addr> [param*]
2752 Used to configure a log udp listener to receive messages to forward.
2753 Only udp listeners are allowed, address must be prefixed using
2754 'udp@', 'udp4@' or 'udp6@'. This supports for all "bind" parameters
2755 found in 5.1 paragraph but most of them are irrelevant for udp/syslog case.
2756
2757log global
2758log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2759 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2760 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
2761 documentation.
2762 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
2763 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
2764 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
2765 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
2766 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
2767
2768 Example:
2769 global
2770 log stderr format iso local7
2771
2772 ring myring
2773 description "My local buffer"
2774 format rfc5424
2775 maxlen 1200
2776 size 32764
2777 timeout connect 5s
2778 timeout server 10s
2779 # syslog tcp server
2780 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
2781
2782 log-forward sylog-loadb
2783 bind udp4@127.0.0.1:1514
2784 # all messages on stderr
2785 log global
2786 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
2787 log ring@myring local0
2788 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
2789 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
2790 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
2791 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
2792 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002793
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027944. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002795----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002796
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002797Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002798 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002799 - frontend <name>
2800 - backend <name>
2801 - listen <name>
2802
2803A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2804its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2805section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002806section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002807
2808A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2809connections.
2810
2811A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2812to forward incoming connections.
2813
2814A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2815parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2816
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002817All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2818'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2819case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2820
2821Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2822logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2823proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2824However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2825name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2826
2827Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2828and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002829bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002830protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2831modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2832arbitrary criteria.
2833
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002834In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2835a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002836the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002837
2838 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2839 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2840 between responses and new requests.
2841
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002842 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2843 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2844 client-facing connection remains open.
2845
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002846 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2847 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002848
2849The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2850frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2851following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002852weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002853
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002854 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002855
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002856 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2857 ----+-----+-----+----
2858 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2859 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002860 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2861 ----+-----+-----+----
2862 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002863
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002864
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002865
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028664.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2867--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002868
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002869The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2870limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2871they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2872limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002873marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002874option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002875and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2876with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2877specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002878
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002879
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002880 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2881------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2882acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002883backlog X X X -
2884balance X - X X
2885bind - X X -
2886bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002887capture cookie - X X -
2888capture request header - X X -
2889capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09002890clitcpka-cnt X X X -
2891clitcpka-idle X X X -
2892clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002893compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002894cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002895declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002896default-server X - X X
2897default_backend X X X -
2898description - X X X
2899disabled X X X X
2900dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002901email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002902email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002903email-alert mailers X X X X
2904email-alert myhostname X X X X
2905email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002906enabled X X X X
2907errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002908errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002909errorloc X X X X
2910errorloc302 X X X X
2911-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2912errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002913force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002914filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002915fullconn X - X X
2916grace X X X X
2917hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002918http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002919http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002920http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002921http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002922http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02002923http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002924http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002925http-check set-var X - X X
2926http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02002927http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002928http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002929http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002930http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002931http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002932id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002933ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002934load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002935log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002936log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002937log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002938log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002939max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002940maxconn X X X -
2941mode X X X X
2942monitor fail - X X -
2943monitor-net X X X -
2944monitor-uri X X X -
2945option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2946option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2947option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2948option allbackups (*) X - X X
2949option checkcache (*) X - X X
2950option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2951option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02002952option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002953option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2954option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002955-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2956option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002957option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2958option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002959option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002960option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002961option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002962option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002963option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002964option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2965option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2966option httpchk X - X X
2967option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002968option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002969option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002970option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002971option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002972option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002973option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2974option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2975option logasap (*) X X X -
2976option mysql-check X - X X
2977option nolinger (*) X X X X
2978option originalto X X X X
2979option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002980option pgsql-check X - X X
2981option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002982option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002983option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002984option smtpchk X - X X
2985option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2986option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2987option splice-request (*) X X X X
2988option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002989option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002990option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2991option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2992-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002993option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002994option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2995option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2996option tcpka X X X X
2997option tcplog X X X X
2998option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002999external-check command X - X X
3000external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003001persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3002rate-limit sessions X X X -
3003redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003004-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003005retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003006retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003007server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003008server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003009server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003010source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003011srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3012srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3013srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003014stats admin - X X X
3015stats auth X X X X
3016stats enable X X X X
3017stats hide-version X X X X
3018stats http-request - X X X
3019stats realm X X X X
3020stats refresh X X X X
3021stats scope X X X X
3022stats show-desc X X X X
3023stats show-legends X X X X
3024stats show-node X X X X
3025stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003026-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3027stick match - - X X
3028stick on - - X X
3029stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003030stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003031stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003032tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003033tcp-check connect X - X X
3034tcp-check expect X - X X
3035tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003036tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003037tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003038tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003039tcp-check set-var X - X X
3040tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003041tcp-request connection - X X -
3042tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003043tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003044tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003045tcp-response content - - X X
3046tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003047timeout check X - X X
3048timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003049timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003050timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003051timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3052timeout http-request X X X X
3053timeout queue X - X X
3054timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003055timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003056timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003057timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003058transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003059unique-id-format X X X -
3060unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003061use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003062use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003063use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003064------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3065 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003066
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003067
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020030684.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3069---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003070
3071This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3072
3073
3074acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3075 Declare or complete an access list.
3076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3077 no | yes | yes | yes
3078 Example:
3079 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3080 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3081 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3082
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003083 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003084
3085
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003086backlog <conns>
3087 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3089 yes | yes | yes | no
3090 Arguments :
3091 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3092 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003093 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003094
3095 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3096 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3097 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3098 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3099 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3100 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3101 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3102 backlog parameter.
3103
3104 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3105 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3106 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3107
3108 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3109
3110
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003111balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003112balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003113 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3115 yes | no | yes | yes
3116 Arguments :
3117 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3118 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3119 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3120 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3121
3122 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3123 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3124 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3125 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003126 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003127 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003128 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3129 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3130 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3131 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3132 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3133 it, so that you don't worry.
3134
3135 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3136 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3137 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3138 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3139 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3140 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3141 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3142 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003143
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003144 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3145 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3146 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3147 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3148 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3149 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3150 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
3151 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
3152
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003153 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003154 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003155 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3156 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003157 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003158 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3159 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3160 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3161 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3162 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003163 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3164 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3165 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3166 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3167 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3168 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003169
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003170 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3171 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3172 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3173 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3174 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3175 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3176 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3177 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003178 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003179 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003180 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3181 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3182 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003183
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003184 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3185 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3186 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3187 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3188 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3189 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3190 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3191 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3192 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3193 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3194 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3195 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003196
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003197 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003198 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3199 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3200 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3201 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3202 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3203 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3204 URIs start with a leading "/".
3205
3206 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3207 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3208 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3209 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3210
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003211 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003212 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3213
3214 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003215 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3216 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003217 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3218 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3219 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3220 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003221 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003222 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3223 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003224
3225 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3226 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3227 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3228 server will receive the request.
3229
3230 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3231 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3232 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3233 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3234 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003235 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3236 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3237 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003238
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003239 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3240 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3241 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3242 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3243 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003244
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003245 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003246 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3247 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3248 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3249
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003250 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3251 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3252 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3253
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003254 random
3255 random(<draws>)
3256 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003257 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3258 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3259 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3260 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003261 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3262 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3263 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3264 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3265 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3266 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3267 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3268 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3269 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3270 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3271 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3272 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3273 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3274 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3275 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3276 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3277 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3278 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3279 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3280 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003281
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003282 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003283 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003284 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3285 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3286 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3287 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3288 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3289 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003290 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003291 used instead.
3292
3293 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3294 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3295 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3296 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3297
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003298 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3299 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3300 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3301
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003302 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003303
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003304 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003305 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3306 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003307
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003308 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3309 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3310 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003311
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003312 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003313 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003314 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3315 NTLM relies on.
3316
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003317 Examples :
3318 balance roundrobin
3319 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003320 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003321 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3322 balance hdr(host)
3323 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003324
3325 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3326 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3327
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003328 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003329 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3330 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3331 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003332 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003333
3334 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3335 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3336 defaults to 16 kB.
3337
3338 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3339 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3340
3341 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3342 Round Robin.
3343
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003344 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003345 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3346 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3347 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3348
3349 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3350
3351 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003352 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003353 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3354 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3355 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003356
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003357 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003358
3359
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003360bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3361bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003362 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3364 no | yes | yes | no
3365 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003366 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3367 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3368 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3369 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003370 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003371 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3372 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3373 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3374 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3375 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3376 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003377 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003378 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
3379 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003380 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003381 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3382 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003383 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003384 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3385 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003386 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003387 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3388 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3389 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3390 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3391 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3392 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3393 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003394 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3395 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3396 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003397 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3398 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3399 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3400 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003401 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3402 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3403 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003404
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003405 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3406 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003407 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3408 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3409 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003410 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3411 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3412 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3413 the range.
3414
3415 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3416 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3417 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3418 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3419 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3420 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3421 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003422 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003423 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003424
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003425 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003426 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003427 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3428 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3429 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3430 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3431 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3432 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3433
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003434 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3435 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3436 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3437 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003438
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003439 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3440 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3441 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3442 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3443 in a frontend.
3444
3445 Example :
3446 listen http_proxy
3447 bind :80,:443
3448 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003449 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003450
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003451 listen http_https_proxy
3452 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003453 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003454
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003455 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3456 bind ipv6@:80
3457 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3458 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3459
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003460 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003461 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003462
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003463 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3464 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3465 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3466 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3467 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3468
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003469 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003470 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003471
3472
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003473bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003474 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3476 yes | yes | yes | yes
3477 Arguments :
3478 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3479 may be used to override a default value.
3480
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003481 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003482 option may be combined with other numbers.
3483
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003484 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003485 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3486 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3487 missing from all processes.
3488
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003489 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003490 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003491 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3492 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3493 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3494 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3495 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003496 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003497
3498 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3499 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3500 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3501 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3502 and 'even' instances.
3503
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003504 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3505 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3506 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3507 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003508
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003509 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3510 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3511
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003512 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3513 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3514 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3515
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003516 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3517 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3518
3519 Example :
3520 listen app_ip1
3521 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003522 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003523
3524 listen app_ip2
3525 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003526 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003527
3528 listen management
3529 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003530 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003531
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003532 listen management
3533 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3534 bind-process 1-4
3535
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003536 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003537
3538
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003539capture cookie <name> len <length>
3540 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3542 no | yes | yes | no
3543 Arguments :
3544 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3545 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3546 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3547 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003548 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003549
3550 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3551 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3552 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3553 right if it exceeds <length>.
3554
3555 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3556 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3557 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3558 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3559
3560 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3561 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3562 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3563
3564 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3565 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3566 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003567 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3568 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3569 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003570
3571 Example:
3572 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3573
3574 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003575 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003576
3577
3578capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003579 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3581 no | yes | yes | no
3582 Arguments :
3583 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003584 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003585 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3586 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3587 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3588
3589 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3590 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3591 it exceeds <length>.
3592
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003593 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003594 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3595 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003596 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3597 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3598 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3599 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003600 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003601 environments to find where the request came from.
3602
3603 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3604 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3605 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3606 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003607
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003608 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3609 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3610 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3611 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3612 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003613
3614 Example:
3615 capture request header Host len 15
3616 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003617 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003618
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003619 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003620 about logging.
3621
3622
3623capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003624 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3626 no | yes | yes | no
3627 Arguments :
3628 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003629 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003630 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3631 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3632 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3633
3634 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3635 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3636 it exceeds <length>.
3637
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003638 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003639 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3640 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3641 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003642 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3643 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3644 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3645 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003646
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003647 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3648 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3649 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3650 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3651 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003652
3653 Example:
3654 capture response header Content-length len 9
3655 capture response header Location len 15
3656
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003657 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003658 about logging.
3659
3660
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003661clitcpka-cnt <count>
3662 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
3663 the connection on the client side.
3664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3665 yes | yes | yes | no
3666 Arguments :
3667 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
3668
3669 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
3670 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003671 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3672 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003673
3674 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
3675
3676
3677clitcpka-idle <timeout>
3678 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
3679 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
3680 client side.
3681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3682 yes | yes | yes | no
3683 Arguments :
3684 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
3685 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
3686 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
3687 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
3688
3689 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
3690 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003691 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3692 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003693
3694 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
3695
3696
3697clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
3698 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
3699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3700 yes | yes | yes | no
3701 Arguments :
3702 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
3703 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
3704 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
3705 document.
3706
3707 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
3708 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003709 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3710 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003711
3712 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
3713
3714
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003715compression algo <algorithm> ...
3716compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003717compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003718 Enable HTTP compression.
3719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3720 yes | yes | yes | yes
3721 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003722 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3723 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3724 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3725
3726 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003727 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3728 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3729 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003730
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003731 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003732 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003733
3734 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3735 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3736 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3737 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3738 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003739 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003740
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003741 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3742 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3743 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3744 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3745 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3746 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3747 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003748 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003749
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003750 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003751 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003752 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3753 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3754 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3755 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3756 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003757
3758 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3759 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3760 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3761 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3762 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003763 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3764 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3765 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3766 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3767 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003768 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3769 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003770
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003771 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003772 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3773 "Accept-Encoding" header
3774 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003775 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003776 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3777 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3778 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3779 "multipart"
3780 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3781 header
3782 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3783 and later
3784 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3785 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003786 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003787
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003788 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003789
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003790 Examples :
3791 compression algo gzip
3792 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003793
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003794
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003795cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003796 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3797 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003798 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003799 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3801 yes | no | yes | yes
3802 Arguments :
3803 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3804 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3805 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3806 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3807 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3808 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003809 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003810 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3811 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3812
3813 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3814 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3815 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3816 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3817 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3818 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003819 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3820 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003821 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003822 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3823 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003824
3825 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003826 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003827
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003828 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003829 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003830 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003831 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003832 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3833 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3834 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3835 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3836 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3837 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3838 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003839
3840 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3841 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3842 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3843 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3844 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3845 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3846 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3847 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3848 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003849 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003850 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3851 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3852 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003853
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003854 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3855 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3856 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003857 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3858 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3859 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3860 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003861 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3862 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3863 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003864
3865 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3866 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3867 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3868 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3869 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3870 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3871 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3872 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3873 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3874
3875 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3876 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3877 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3878 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3879 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3880 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3881 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3882 persistence cookie in the cache.
3883 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3884
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003885 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3886 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3887 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3888 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3889 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003890 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003891 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3892 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3893 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3894 they logout.
3895
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003896 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3897 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3898 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3899 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3900
3901 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3902 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3903 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3904 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3905 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3906 this attribute.
3907
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003908 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003909 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003910 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3911 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3912 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3913 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3914 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3915 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003916
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003917 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3918 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3919 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3920 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3921 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3922 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3923 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3924 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003925 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003926 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3927 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3928 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3929 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3930 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3931 the site.
3932
3933 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3934 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3935 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3936 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3937 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3938 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3939 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3940 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3941 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3942 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3943 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3944 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3945 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003946 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003947 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3948 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3949
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003950 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3951 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3952 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3953 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3954 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3955 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3956
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003957 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3958 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3959 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3960 repeated.
3961
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003962 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3963 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3964 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3965 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003966
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003967 Examples :
3968 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3969 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3970 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003971 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003972
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003973 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003974
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003975
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003976declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3977 Declares a capture slot.
3978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3979 no | yes | yes | no
3980 Arguments:
3981 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3982
3983 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3984 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3985 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3986 for use in the response.
3987
3988 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003989 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003990 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3991
3992
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003993default-server [param*]
3994 Change default options for a server in a backend
3995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3996 yes | no | yes | yes
3997 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003998 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3999 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4000 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4001 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004002
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004003 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004004 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4005
4006 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004007
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004008
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004009default_backend <backend>
4010 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4012 yes | yes | yes | no
4013 Arguments :
4014 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4015
4016 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4017 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4018 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4019 will catch all undetermined requests.
4020
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004021 Example :
4022
4023 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4024 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4025 default_backend dynamic
4026
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004027 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004028
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004029
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004030description <string>
4031 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4033 no | yes | yes | yes
4034 Arguments : string
4035
4036 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4037 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4038 it describes.
4039 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4040
4041
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004042disabled
4043 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4045 yes | yes | yes | yes
4046 Arguments : none
4047
4048 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4049 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4050 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4051 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4052 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4053 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4054 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4055
4056 See also : "enabled"
4057
4058
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004059dispatch <address>:<port>
4060 Set a default server address
4061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4062 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004063 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004064
4065 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4066 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4067 during start-up.
4068
4069 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4070 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4071 possible with normal servers.
4072
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004073 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004074 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4075 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4076 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4077 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4078
4079 See also : "server"
4080
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004081
4082dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4083 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4085 yes | no | yes | yes
4086 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4087
4088 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004089 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004090 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4091 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004092 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004093 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004094
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004095enabled
4096 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4098 yes | yes | yes | yes
4099 Arguments : none
4100
4101 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4102 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4103
4104 See also : "disabled"
4105
4106
4107errorfile <code> <file>
4108 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4110 yes | yes | yes | yes
4111 Arguments :
4112 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004113 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004114 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004115
4116 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004117 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004118 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004119 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4120 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004121
4122 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4123 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4124 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4125
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004126 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4127
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004128 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4129 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4130 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4131 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4132 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4133 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4134 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4135 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4136 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004137
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004138 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4139 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4140 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004141 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004142 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4143
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004144 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004145
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004146 Example :
4147 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004148 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004149 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4150 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4151
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004152
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004153errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4154 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4155 section.
4156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4157 yes | yes | yes | yes
4158 Arguments :
4159 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4160
4161 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004162 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004163 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004164
4165 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4166 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4167 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4168 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4169 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004170 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004171 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4172
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004173 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4174 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004175
4176 Example :
4177 errorfiles generic
4178 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4179
4180
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004181errorloc <code> <url>
4182errorloc302 <code> <url>
4183 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4185 yes | yes | yes | yes
4186 Arguments :
4187 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004188 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004189 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004190
4191 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4192 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4193 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4194 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004195 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004196
4197 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4198 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4199 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4200
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004201 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4202
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004203 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4204 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4205 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4206 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004207 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004208 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4209 request.
4210
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004211 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004212
4213
4214errorloc303 <code> <url>
4215 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4217 yes | yes | yes | yes
4218 Arguments :
4219 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004220 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004221 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004222
4223 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4224 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4225 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4226 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004227 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004228
4229 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4230 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4231 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4232
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004233 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4234
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004235 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4236 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4237 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4238 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004239 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004240
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004241 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004242
4243
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004244email-alert from <emailaddr>
4245 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004246 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004247 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4248 yes | yes | yes | yes
4249
4250 Arguments :
4251
4252 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4253
4254 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4255 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4256
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004257 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004258 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4259 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004260
4261
4262email-alert level <level>
4263 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4264 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4265 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4266 yes | yes | yes | yes
4267
4268 Arguments :
4269
4270 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4271 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4272 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4273
4274 By default level is alert
4275
4276 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4277 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4278 for the proxy.
4279
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004280 Alerts are sent when :
4281
4282 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4283 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4284 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4285 is notice or lower
4286 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4287 and a health check status update occurs
4288
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004289 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4290 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004291 section 3.6 about mailers.
4292
4293
4294email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4295 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4296 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4297 yes | yes | yes | yes
4298
4299 Arguments :
4300
4301 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4302
4303 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4304 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4305
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004306 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4307 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004308
4309
4310email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4311 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4312 mailers.
4313 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4314 yes | yes | yes | yes
4315
4316 Arguments :
4317
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004318 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004319
4320 By default the systems hostname is used.
4321
4322 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4323 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4324 for the proxy.
4325
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004326 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4327 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004328
4329
4330email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004331 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004332 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4333 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4334 yes | yes | yes | yes
4335
4336 Arguments :
4337
4338 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4339
4340 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4341 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4342
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004343 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004344 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4345
4346
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004347force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4348 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4349 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004350 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004351
4352 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4353 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4354 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4355 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4356 marked down for maintenance operations.
4357
4358 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4359 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4360 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4361 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4362 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4363 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4364 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4365 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4366 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4367
4368 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4369 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4370 is used.
4371
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004372 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004373 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004374
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004375
4376filter <name> [param*]
4377 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4379 no | yes | yes | yes
4380 Arguments :
4381 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4382 referenced in section 9.
4383
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004384 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004385 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004386 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4387 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004388
4389 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4390 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4391
4392 Example:
4393 listen
4394 bind *:80
4395
4396 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4397 filter compression
4398 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4399
4400 compression algo gzip
4401 compression offload
4402
4403 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4404
4405 See also : section 9.
4406
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004407
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004408fullconn <conns>
4409 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4411 yes | no | yes | yes
4412 Arguments :
4413 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4414 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4415
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004416 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004417 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004418 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004419 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4420 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4421 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4422 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4423 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004424 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004425
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004426 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4427 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004428 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4429 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4430 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004431
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004432 Example :
4433 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4434 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4435 # connections.
4436 backend dynamic
4437 fullconn 10000
4438 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4439 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4440
4441 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4442
4443
4444grace <time>
4445 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004447 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004448 Arguments :
4449 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4450 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4451 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4452
4453 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4454 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004455 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004456 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4457
4458 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4459 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4460 simplify it.
4461
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004462
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004463hash-balance-factor <factor>
4464 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4466 yes | no | no | yes
4467 Arguments :
4468 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4469 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004470 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004471
4472 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4473 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4474 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4475 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4476 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4477 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4478 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4479
4480 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4481 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4482 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4483 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4484 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4485
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004486 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4487 consistent hashing mechanism.
4488
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004489 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4490
4491
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004492hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004493 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4495 yes | no | yes | yes
4496 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004497 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4498 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004499
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004500 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4501 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4502 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4503 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4504 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4505 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4506 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4507 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4508 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4509 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004510
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004511 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4512 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4513 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4514 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4515 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4516 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4517 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4518 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4519 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4520 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4521 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4522 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4523 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004524 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4525 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004526
4527 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4528
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004529 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004530 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4531 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4532 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004533 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4534 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4535 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004536
4537 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4538 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004539 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4540 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4541 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4542 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4543
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004544 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4545 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4546 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4547 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4548 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4549 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4550 parameter.
4551
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004552 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4553 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4554 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4555 used on strings.
4556
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004557 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4558
4559 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4560 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4561 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4562 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4563 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4564 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4565 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4566 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4567 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4568 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4569 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4570 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004571
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004572 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4573 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4574 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004575
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004576 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004577
4578
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004579http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4580 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4581 ones).
4582
4583 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4584 no | yes | yes | yes
4585
4586 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4587 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4588 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4589 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4590 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4591 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4592
4593 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4594 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4595 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4596
4597 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4598 below.
4599
4600 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4601 instance.
4602
4603 Example:
4604 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4605 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4606 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4607
4608http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4609
4610 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4611 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4612 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4613 example, or to pass some internal information.
4614 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4615 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4616 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4617
4618http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4619
4620 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4621 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4622
4623http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4624
4625 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4626
4627http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4628 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4629
4630 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4631
4632 Example:
4633 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4634
4635 # applied to:
4636 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4637
4638 # outputs:
4639 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4640
4641 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4642
4643http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4644 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4645
4646 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4647
4648 Example:
4649 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4650
4651 # applied to:
4652 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4653
4654 # outputs:
4655 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4656
4657http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4658
4659 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4660 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4661 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4662
4663http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4664 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4665
4666 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4667 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4668 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4669 fallback.
4670
4671 Example:
4672 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4673 http-response set-status 431
4674 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4675 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4676
4677http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4678
4679 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4680 inline.
4681
4682 Arguments:
4683 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4684 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4685 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4686 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4687 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4688 (request and response)
4689 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4690 processing
4691 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4692 processing
4693 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4694 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4695 and '_'.
4696
4697 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4698 followed by some converters.
4699
4700 Example:
4701 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4702
4703http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4704
4705 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4706 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4707 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4708 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4709 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004710 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004711 processing.
4712
4713 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4714 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004715 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004716 rules evaluation.
4717
4718http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4719
4720 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4721 details about <var-name>.
4722
4723 Example:
4724 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4725
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004726
4727http-check comment <string>
4728 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
4729 it fails.
4730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4731 yes | no | yes | yes
4732
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004733 Arguments :
4734 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
4735 rule fails.
4736
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004737 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
4738 user-friendly error reporting.
4739
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004740 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004741 "http-check expect".
4742
4743
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004744http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
4745 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004746 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004747 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
4748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4749 yes | no | yes | yes
4750
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004751 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004752 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4753
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004754 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004755 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004756
4757 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
4758 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
4759 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
4760 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
4761
4762 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
4763
4764 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
4765
4766 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
4767
4768 ssl opens a ciphered connection
4769
4770 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
4771
4772 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
4773 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
4774 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
4775 is used.
4776
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004777 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
4778 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
4779 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
4780 haproxy -vv.
4781
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004782 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
4783
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004784 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
4785 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
4786 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
4787 different ports or with different servers.
4788
4789 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
4790 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
4791 the port with a "http-check connect".
4792
4793 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
4794 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
4795 do.
4796
4797 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
4798 unset-var or comment rules.
4799
4800 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004801 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
4802 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
4803 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
4804 option httpchk
4805
4806 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004807 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004808 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004809 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004810 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004811 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004812
4813 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
4814
4815 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004816
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004817
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004818http-check disable-on-404
4819 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004821 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004822 Arguments : none
4823
4824 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4825 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4826 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4827 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4828 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4829 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4830 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4831 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004832 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4833 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4834 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4835
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004836 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004837
4838
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004839http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004840 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
4841 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
4842 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004843 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004845 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004846
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004847 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004848 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4849
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004850 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
4851 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
4852 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
4853 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
4854 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
4855 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
4856 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
4857 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
4858 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
4859 result is always conclusive.
4860
4861 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4862 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
4863 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004864 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
4865 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
4866 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
4867 example 404 with disable-on-404
4868 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
4869 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
4870 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004871
4872 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4873 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004874 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
4875 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
4876 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
4877 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
4878 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
4879 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004880
4881 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4882 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004883 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
4884 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
4885 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
4886 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004887 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
4888
4889 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4890 informational message reported in logs if the expect
4891 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
4892 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
4893
4894 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4895 informational message reported in logs if an error
4896 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
4897 log-format string.
4898
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004899 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004900 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
4901 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004902 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4903 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4904 details on the supported keywords.
4905
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004906 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
4907 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
4908 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
4909 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004910
4911 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4912 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4913 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4914 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4915 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4916
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004917 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
4918 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
4919 codes. A health check response will be considered as
4920 valid if the response's status code matches any status
4921 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
4922 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4923 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004924
4925 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004926 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004927 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4928 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4929 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4930 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4931
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004932 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
4933 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004934 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
4935 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
4936 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
4937 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
4938 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
4939 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
4940 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
4941 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004942 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
4943 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
4944 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
4945 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
4946 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
4947 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
4948 insensitive on the header names.
4949
4950 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
4951 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
4952 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
4953 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
4954 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
4955 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004956
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004957 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004958 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004959 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4960 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4961 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4962 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4963 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004964 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004965 trace).
4966
4967 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004968 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004969 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4970 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4971 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4972 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4973 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004974 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004975
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02004976 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
4977 A health check response will be considered valid if the
4978 response's body contains the string resulting of the
4979 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
4980 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4981 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
4982
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004983 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4984 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4985 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4986 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4987 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4988 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4989 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4990 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4991
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004992 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
4993 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
4994 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
4995 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
4996 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004997
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004998 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4999 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5000
5001 Examples :
5002 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005003 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005004
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005005 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5006 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5007
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005008 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005009 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005010
5011 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005012 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005013
5014 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005015 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005016
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005017 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005018 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005019
5020
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005021http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005022 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5023 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005024 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5025 health checks.
5026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5027 yes | no | yes | yes
5028 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005029 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5030
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005031 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5032 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5033 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5034 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5035 to invent non-standard ones.
5036
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005037 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5038 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5039 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5040 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5041
5042 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5043 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5044 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5045 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005046
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005047 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005048 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005049 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005050 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5051 to add it.
5052
5053 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5054 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5055 to the log-format rules.
5056
5057 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5058 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5059 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005060
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005061 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5062 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5063 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5064 request.
5065
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005066 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5067 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5068 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005069 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5070 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5071 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5072 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005073 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005074 "http-check expect" directive is defined independently of this directive, just
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005075 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
5076
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005077 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
5078 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005079 header should not be present in the request provided by "http-check send". If
5080 so, it will be ignored.
5081
5082 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5083 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5084 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5085 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5086 configured request authority.
5087
5088 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5089 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005090
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005091 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005092
5093
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005094http-check send-state
5095 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5097 yes | no | yes | yes
5098 Arguments : none
5099
5100 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5101 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5102 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5103 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5104 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5105
5106 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5107 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5108 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5109 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5110 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005111 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5112 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5113 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5114
5115 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5116 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5117 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5118
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005119 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5120 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5121 checked in multiple backends.
5122
5123 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5124 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5125
5126 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5127 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5128 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5129 one fails.
5130
5131 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5132 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5133 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5134
5135 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5136 server's queue.
5137
5138 Example of a header received by the application server :
5139 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5140 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5141
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005142 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5143 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005144
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005145
5146http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005147 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005148 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5149 yes | no | yes | yes
5150
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005151 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005152 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5153 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5154 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5155 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5156 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5157 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5158 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5159 and '-'.
5160
5161 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5162
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005163 Examples :
5164 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005165
5166
5167http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005168 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005169 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5170 yes | no | yes | yes
5171
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005172 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005173 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5174 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5175 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5176 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5177 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5178 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5179 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5180 and '-'.
5181
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005182 Examples :
5183 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005184
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005185
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005186http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5187 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5188 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5189 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5190 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5192 yes | yes | yes | yes
5193 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005194 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005195 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005196 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
5197 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005198
5199 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5200 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5201 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5202 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5203
5204 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5205 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5206 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5207 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5208
5209 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5210 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5211 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5212 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5213 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5214 chroot is performed.
5215
5216 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5217 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5218 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5219 considered.
5220
5221 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5222 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5223 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5224 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5225 considered as a raw string.
5226
5227 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5228 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5229 "content-type".
5230
5231 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5232 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5233 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5234 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5235 evaluated as a log-format string.
5236
5237 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5238 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5239 argument to "content-type".
5240
5241 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5242 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5243 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5244 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5245
5246 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5247 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5248 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5249 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5250 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5251 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5252 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5253 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5254
5255 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5256 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5257 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5258
5259 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5260 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5261
5262
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005263http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005264 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5265
5266 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5267 no | yes | yes | yes
5268
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005269 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5270 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5271 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5272 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5273 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005274
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005275 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5276 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005277
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005278 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005279
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005280 Example:
5281 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5282 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5283 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005284
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005285 http-request allow if nagios
5286 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5287 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5288 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005289
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005290 Example:
5291 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5292 acl add path /addacl
5293 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005294
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005295 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005296
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005297 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5298 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005299
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005300 Example:
5301 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5302 acl setmap path /setmap
5303 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005304
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005305 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005306
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005307 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5308 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005309
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005310 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5311 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005312
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005313http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005314
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005315 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5316 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5317 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5318 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5319 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5320 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5321 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5322 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005323
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005324http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005325
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005326 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5327 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5328 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5329 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5330 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5331 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5332 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5333 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005334
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005335http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005336
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005337 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5338 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005339
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005340
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005341http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005342
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005343 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5344 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5345 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5346 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5347 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005348
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005349 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5350 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5351 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5352 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5353 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5354 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5355 instead.
5356
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005357 Example:
5358 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5359 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005360
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005361http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005362
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005363 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005364
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005365http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5366 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005367
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005368 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5369 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5370 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5371 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5372 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5373 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5374 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5375 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5376 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005377
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005378 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5379 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5380 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005381 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5382
5383 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5384 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5385 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5386 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005387
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005388http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005389
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005390 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5391 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5392 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5393 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5394 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5395 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005396
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005397http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005398
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005399 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005400
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005401http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005402
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005403 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5404 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5405 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5406 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5407 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5408 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005409
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005410http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5411http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5412 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5413 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5414 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5415 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005416
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005417 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5418 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5419 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005420 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005421 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5422 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5423 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005424 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005425 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005426
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005427http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5428 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5429 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5430 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5431
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005432http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5433
5434 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5435 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5436 pointed by <resolvers>.
5437 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5438 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5439 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5440 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5441 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5442 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5443 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5444 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5445 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5446 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5447 to 0.0.0.0.
5448
5449 Example:
5450 resolvers mydns
5451 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5452 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5453 timeout retry 1s
5454 hold valid 10s
5455 hold nx 3s
5456 hold other 3s
5457 hold obsolete 0s
5458 accepted_payload_size 8192
5459
5460 frontend fe
5461 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5462 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5463 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5464
5465 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5466 # which mean DNS resolution error
5467 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5468
5469 default_backend be
5470
5471 backend b_503
5472 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5473 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5474 # 503 error page to end users
5475
5476 backend be
5477 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5478 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5479 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5480 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5481 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5482
5483 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5484 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5485
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005486http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5487
5488 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5489 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5490 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5491 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005492 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5493 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005494
5495 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5496
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005497http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005498
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005499 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5500 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5501 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5502 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5503 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005504
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005505http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005506
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005507 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5508 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5509 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5510 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005511
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005512http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5513 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005514
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005515 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005516 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5517 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5518 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5519 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5520 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005521
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005522 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5523 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5524 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5525 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5526 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005527
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005528 Example:
5529 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5530
5531 # applied to:
5532 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5533
5534 # outputs:
5535 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5536
5537 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005538
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005539 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5540
5541 # applied to:
5542 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005543
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005544 # outputs:
5545 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005546
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005547http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5548 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5549
5550 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5551 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
5552 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
5553 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
5554
5555 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5556 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5557 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5558
5559 Example:
5560 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5561 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5562
5563 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5564 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5565
5566 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5567 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5568 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5569 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5570
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005571http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5572 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5573
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005574 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5575 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5576 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5577 against.
5578
5579 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5580 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5581 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005582
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005583 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5584 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5585 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5586 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5587 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5588 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5589 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5590 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5591 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005592 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5593 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005594
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005595 Example:
5596 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5597 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005598
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005599 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5600 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005601
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005602http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5603 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005604
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005605 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5606 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5607 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5608 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005609
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005610 Example:
5611 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005612
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005613 # applied to:
5614 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005615
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005616 # outputs:
5617 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005618
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005619http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5620 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5621 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005622 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005623 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5624
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005625 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005626 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5627 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005628 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005629 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005630 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005631 are followed to create the response :
5632
5633 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5634 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5635 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5636 ignored.
5637
5638 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5639 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005640 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005641 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
5642 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005643
5644 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5645 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5646 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005647 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005648 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005649
5650 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5651 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5652 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005653 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005654 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
5655 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005656
5657 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5658 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5659 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5660 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5661 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5662 as a raw content.
5663
5664 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5665 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5666 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5667 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5668 considered as a raw string.
5669
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005670 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5671 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5672 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5673 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5674
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005675 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5676 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005677 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005678
5679 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5680
5681 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005682 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005683 if { path /ping }
5684
5685 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
5686 if { path /favicon.ico }
5687
5688 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
5689 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
5690 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
5691
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005692http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5693http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005694
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005695 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5696 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5697 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005698
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005699http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5700 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005701
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005702 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5703 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5704 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5705 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005706
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005707http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005708
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005709 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
5710 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
5711 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
5712 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
5713 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005714
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005715 Arguments:
5716 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5717 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005718
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005719 Example:
5720 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
5721 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005722
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005723 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
5724 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005725
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005726http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005727
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005728 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
5729 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
5730 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005731
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005732 Arguments:
5733 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5734 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005735
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005736 Example:
5737 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
5738 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005739
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005740 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
5741 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
5742 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005743
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005744http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005745
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005746 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
5747 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5748 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5749 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
5750 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005751
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005752 Example:
5753 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
5754 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
5755 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
5756 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
5757 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
5758 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
5759 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
5760 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
5761 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005762
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005763http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005764
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005765 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5766 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5767 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5768 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
5769 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005770
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005771http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5772 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005773
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005774 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5775 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5776 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5777 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5778 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
5779 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
5780 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
5781 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5782 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005783
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005784http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005785
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005786 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5787 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5788 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5789 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5790 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5791 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5792 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005793
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005794http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005795
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005796 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5797 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5798 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005799
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005800http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005801
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005802 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5803 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5804 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5805 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5806 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5807 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5808 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5809 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005810
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005811http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005812
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005813 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5814 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5815 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5816 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5817 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5818 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005819
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005820 Example :
5821 # prepend the host name before the path
5822 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005823
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005824http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005825
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005826 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5827 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5828 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5829 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5830 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005831
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005832http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005833
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005834 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5835 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5836 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5837 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5838 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5839 values have higher priority.
5840 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5841 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5842 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5843 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5844 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005845
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005846http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005847
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005848 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5849 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5850 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5851 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5852 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5853 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5854 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005855
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005856 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005857
5858 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005859 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5860 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005861
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005862http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5863 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5864 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5865 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005866 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
5867 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005868
5869 Arguments :
5870 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5871 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005872
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005873 See also "option forwardfor".
5874
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005875 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005876 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5877 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5878
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005879 # After the masking this will track connections
5880 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
5881 http-request track-sc0 src
5882
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005883 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5884 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5885
5886http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5887
5888 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5889 expression.
5890
5891 Arguments:
5892 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5893 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005894
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005895 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005896 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5897 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5898
5899 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5900 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5901 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5902
5903http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5904
5905 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5906 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5907 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5908 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5909 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5910 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5911 information from the request.
5912
5913 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5914
5915http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5916
5917 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
5918 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
5919 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
5920 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
5921 path and the query string.
5922 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
5923
5924http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5925
5926 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5927 inline.
5928
5929 Arguments:
5930 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5931 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5932 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5933 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5934 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5935 (request and response)
5936 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5937 processing
5938 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5939 processing
5940 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5941 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
5942 and '_'.
5943
5944 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5945 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005946
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005947 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005948 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005949
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005950http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
5951 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005952
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005953 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5954 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5955 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5956 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5957 agent name must be used.
5958
5959 Arguments:
5960 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
5961
5962 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5963 configuration.
5964
5965http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5966
5967 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5968 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5969 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5970 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5971 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5972 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5973 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5974 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5975 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5976 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5977 action.
5978 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5979 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5980 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5981 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5982 you fully understand how it works.
5983
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005984http-request strict-mode { on | off }
5985
5986 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5987 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5988 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5989 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5990 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005991 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005992 processing.
5993
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005994 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005995 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5996 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
5997 rules evaluation.
5998
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005999http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6000http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6001 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6002 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6003 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6004 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006005
6006 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6007 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6008 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006009 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6010 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6011 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6012 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6013 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6014 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6015 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6016 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6017 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6018 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006019 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006020 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6021 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6022 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6023 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6024 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006025
6026http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6027http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6028http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6029
6030 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6031 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6032 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6033 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
6034 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
6035 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6036 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6037 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6038 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6039 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6040 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6041 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6042
6043 Arguments :
6044 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6045 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6046 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6047 select which table entry to update the counters.
6048
6049 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6050 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6051 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6052 that table until the session ends.
6053
6054 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6055 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6056 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6057 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6058 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6059 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6060 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6061 useful information.
6062
6063 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6064 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6065 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6066 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6067 checks that make use of it.
6068
6069http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6070
6071 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006072
6073 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006074 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006075
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006076http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6077
6078 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6079 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6080 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6081 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6082 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6083 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6084
6085 Arguments :
6086 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6087
6088 Example:
6089 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6090
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006091http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006092
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006093 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6094 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6095 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006096
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006097
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006098http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006099 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6100
6101 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6102 no | yes | yes | yes
6103
6104 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6105 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6106 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6107 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6108 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6109 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6110
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006111 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6112 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006113
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006114 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006115
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006116 Example:
6117 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006118
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006119 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006120
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006121 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6122 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006123
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006124 Example:
6125 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006126
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006127 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006128
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006129 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6130 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006131
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006132 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6133 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006134
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006135http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006136
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006137 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6138 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6139 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6140 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6141 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6142 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6143 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6144 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006145
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006146http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006147
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006148 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6149 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6150 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6151 example, or to pass some internal information.
6152 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6153 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6154 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006155
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006156http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006157
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006158 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6159 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006160
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006161http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006162
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006163 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006164
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006165http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006166
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006167 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6168 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6169 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6170 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6171 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6172 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6173 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006174
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006175 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6176 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6177 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6178 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6179 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006180
6181 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6182 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6183 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6184 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006185
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006186http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006187
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006188 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6189 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6190 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6191 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6192 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6193 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006194
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006195http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006196
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006197 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006198
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006199http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006200
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006201 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6202 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6203 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6204 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6205 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6206 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006207
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006208http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6209http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6210 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6211 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6212 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6213 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006214
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006215 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6216 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6217 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006218 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006219 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6220 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6221 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006222 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006223 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006224
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006225http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006226
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006227 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6228 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6229 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6230 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6231 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6232 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006233
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006234http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6235 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006236
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006237 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6238 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006239
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006240 Example:
6241 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006242
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006243 # applied to:
6244 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006245
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006246 # outputs:
6247 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006248
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006249 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006250
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006251http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6252 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006253
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006254 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006255 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006256
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006257 Example:
6258 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006259
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006260 # applied to:
6261 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006262
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006263 # outputs:
6264 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006265
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006266http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6267 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6268 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006269 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006270 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6271
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006272 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006273 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6274 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006275 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006276 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006277 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006278 are followed to create the response :
6279
6280 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6281 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6282 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6283 ignored.
6284
6285 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6286 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006287 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006288 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
6289 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006290
6291 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6292 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6293 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006294 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006295 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006296
6297 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6298 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6299 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006300 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006301 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
6302 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006303
6304 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6305 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6306 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6307 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6308 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6309 as a raw content.
6310
6311 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6312 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6313 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6314 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6315 considered as a raw string.
6316
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006317 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6318 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6319 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6320 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6321
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006322 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6323 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006324 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006325
6326 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6327
6328 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006329 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006330 if { status eq 404 }
6331
6332 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6333 string "This is the end !" \
6334 if { status eq 500 }
6335
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006336http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6337http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006338
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006339 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6340 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6341 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006342
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006343http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6344 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006345
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006346 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6347 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6348 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6349 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006350
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006351http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006352
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006353 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6354 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6355 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6356 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6357 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006358
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006359 Arguments:
6360 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006361
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006362 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6363 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006364
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006365http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006366
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006367 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6368 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6369 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006370
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006371http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6372
6373 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6374 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6375 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6376 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6377 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6378
6379http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6380
6381 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6382 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6383 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6384 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6385 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6386 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6387 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6388 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
6389 be triggered by an HTTP response.
6390
6391http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6392
6393 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6394 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6395 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6396 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
6397 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
6398 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
6399 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
6400
6401http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6402
6403 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
6404 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
6405 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
6406 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
6407 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
6408 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6409 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6410 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
6411
6412http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6413 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6414
6415 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
6416 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
6417 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
6418 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006419
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006420 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006421 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
6422 http-response set-status 431
6423 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
6424 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006425
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006426http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006427
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006428 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6429 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6430 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6431 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6432 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6433 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6434 based on some information from the request.
6435
6436 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6437
6438http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6439
6440 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6441 inline.
6442
6443 Arguments:
6444 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6445 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6446 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6447 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6448 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6449 (request and response)
6450 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6451 processing
6452 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6453 processing
6454 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6455 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6456 and '_'.
6457
6458 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6459 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006460
6461 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006462 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006463
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006464http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006465
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006466 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6467 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6468 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6469 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6470 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6471 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6472 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6473 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6474 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6475 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6476 action.
6477 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6478 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6479 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6480 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6481 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006482
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006483http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6484
6485 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6486 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6487 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6488 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6489 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006490 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006491 processing.
6492
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006493 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006494 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006495 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006496 rules evaluation.
6497
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006498http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6499http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6500http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006501
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006502 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6503 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6504 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6505 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6506 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6507 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6508
6509http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6510
6511 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6512 about <var-name>.
6513
6514 Example:
6515 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6516
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006517
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006518http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6519 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6520
6521 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6522 yes | no | yes | yes
6523
6524 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006525 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6526 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6527 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006528
6529 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6530
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006531 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6532 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6533 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6534 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6535 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6536 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6537 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6538 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6539 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6540 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006541
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006542 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6543 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6544 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6545 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6546 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6547 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6548 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
6549 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006550
6551 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6552 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6553 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6554 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6555 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6556 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6557 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6558 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006559 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006560 downsides of rare connection failures.
6561
6562 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6563 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6564 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6565 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6566 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6567 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006568 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006569 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6570 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6571 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6572 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6573 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6574
6575 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006576 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6577 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6578 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006579
6580 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006581 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006582
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006583 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6584 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006585
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006586 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006587
6588 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6589 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6590 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6591
6592 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6593
6594
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006595http-send-name-header [<header>]
6596 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006597 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6598 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006599 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006600 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6601
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006602 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6603 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6604 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6605 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6606 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
6607 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
6608 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
6609 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
6610 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
6611 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
6612 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
6613 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
6614 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
6615 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
6616 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
6617 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006618
6619 See also : "server"
6620
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006621id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006622 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
6623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6624 no | yes | yes | yes
6625 Arguments : none
6626
6627 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
6628 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
6629 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006630
6631
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006632ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6633 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
6634 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006635 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006636
6637 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
6638 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
6639 and running).
6640
6641 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6642 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
6643 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006644 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006645 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
6646
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006647 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6648 "unless" condition is met.
6649
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006650 Example:
6651 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
6652 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
6653 ignore-persist if url_static
6654
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006655 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
6656
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006657load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
6658 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
6659 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6660 yes | no | yes | yes
6661
6662 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
6663 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
6664 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006665 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006666 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
6667 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
6668 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
6669 over the stats socket and redirect output.
6670
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006671 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006672 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02006673 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006674
6675 Arguments:
6676 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
6677 named "server-state-file".
6678
6679 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
6680 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
6681 name is used as a file name.
6682
6683 none don't load any stat for this backend
6684
6685 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006686 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
6687 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
6688 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006689 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006690 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006691
6692 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
6693 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
6694
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006695 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006696
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006697 global
6698 stats socket /tmp/socket
6699 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006700
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006701 defaults
6702 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006703
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006704 backend bk
6705 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6706 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006707
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006708
6709 Then one can run :
6710
6711 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
6712
6713 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
6714
6715 1
6716 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6717 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6718 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6719
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006720 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006721
6722 global
6723 stats socket /tmp/socket
6724 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
6725
6726 defaults
6727 load-server-state-from-file local
6728
6729 backend bk
6730 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6731 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
6732
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006733
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006734 Then one can run :
6735
6736 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
6737
6738 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
6739
6740 1
6741 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6742 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6743 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6744
6745 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
6746 "show servers state"
6747
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006748
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006749log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006750log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
6751 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006752no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006753 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
6754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6755 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006756
6757 Prefix :
6758 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
6759 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
6760 prefix does not allow arguments.
6761
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006762 Arguments :
6763 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
6764 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
6765 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
6766 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
6767 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
6768 parameter.
6769
6770 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
6771 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
6772
6773 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
6774 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6775 standard syslog port).
6776
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01006777 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
6778 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6779 standard syslog port).
6780
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006781 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
6782 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
6783 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006784 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006785
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006786 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
6787 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
6788 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
6789 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
6790 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
6791 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
6792 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
6793 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
6794 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
6795 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
6796 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
6797 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
6798 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
6799 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
6800 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
6801 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006802 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
6803 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006804
6805 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6806 and "fd@2", see above.
6807
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006808 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6809 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6810 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6811 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6812 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6813 having the logs instantly available.
6814
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006815 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6816 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006817
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006818 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6819 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6820 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6821 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6822 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6823 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6824 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6825 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6826 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6827 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006828 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006829
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006830 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6831 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6832 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6833 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6834 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6835
6836 <sample_size>
6837 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6838 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6839 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6840 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6841 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6842
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006843 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6844 one of the following :
6845
6846 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6847 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6848
6849 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6850 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6851
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02006852 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
6853 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
6854 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
6855 designed to be used with a local log server.
6856
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006857 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6858 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6859 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6860 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6861 systemd logger consumes.
6862
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02006863 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6864 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
6865 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
6866 used with a local log server.
6867
6868 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
6869 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
6870 designed to be used with a local log server.
6871
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006872 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6873 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6874 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6875 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6876
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006877 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6878
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006879 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6880 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6881 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6882
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006883 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6884 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6885 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6886 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006887
6888 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6889 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6890 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006891 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6892 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6893 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6894 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6895 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006896
6897 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6898
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006899 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
6900 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
6901 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006902
6903 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
6904 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
6905 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
6906 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
6907
6908 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
6909 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006910
6911 Example :
6912 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006913 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
6914 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
6915 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006916 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
6917 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006918 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006919
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006920
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006921log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006922 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
6923 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6924 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006925
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006926 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
6927 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
6928 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
6929 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
6930 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006931
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006932 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
6933 "option httplog" directives.
6934
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02006935log-format-sd <string>
6936 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
6937 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6938 yes | yes | yes | no
6939
6940 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
6941 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
6942 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
6943 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
6944 which covers the log format string in depth.
6945
6946 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
6947 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
6948
6949 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
6950 log format to "rfc5424".
6951
6952 Example :
6953 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
6954
6955
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01006956log-tag <string>
6957 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
6958 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6959 yes | yes | yes | yes
6960
6961 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
6962 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
6963 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
6964 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
6965 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
6966 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
6967 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
6968 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
6969 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006970
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006971max-keep-alive-queue <value>
6972 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
6973 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6974 yes | no | yes | yes
6975
6976 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
6977 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
6978 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
6979 servers.
6980
6981 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
6982 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
6983 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
6984 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
6985 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006986 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006987 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
6988 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
6989 picking a different server.
6990
6991 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
6992 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
6993 even if they have to be queued.
6994
6995 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
6996 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
6997
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01006998max-session-srv-conns <nb>
6999 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7000 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7001 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007002
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007003maxconn <conns>
7004 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7006 yes | yes | yes | no
7007 Arguments :
7008 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7009 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7010 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7011 closes.
7012
7013 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7014 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7015 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7016 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007017 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7018 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7019 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7020 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007021
7022 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7023 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7024 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7025
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007026 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7027 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007028
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007029 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7030
7031
7032mode { tcp|http|health }
7033 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7035 yes | yes | yes | yes
7036 Arguments :
7037 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7038 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7039 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7040 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7041
7042 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7043 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7044 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7045 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7046 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7047
7048 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02007049 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
7050 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
7051 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
7052 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
7053 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
7054 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
7055 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007056
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007057 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7058 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7059 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007060
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007061 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007062 defaults http_instances
7063 mode http
7064
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007065 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007066
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007067
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007068monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007069 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7071 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007072 Arguments :
7073 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7074 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007075 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007076 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7077 backend and its backup.
7078
7079 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7080 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7081 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7082 servers in a list of backends.
7083
7084 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7085 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7086 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7087 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7088 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7089 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7090 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007091 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7092 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007093
7094 Example:
7095 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007096 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007097 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7098 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7099 monitor-uri /site_alive
7100 monitor fail if site_dead
7101
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007102 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007103
7104
7105monitor-net <source>
7106 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
7107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7108 yes | yes | yes | no
7109 Arguments :
7110 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
7111 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
7112 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
7113 followed by a mask.
7114
7115 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
7116 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007117 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007118 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
7119
7120 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
7121 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
7122 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
7123 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02007124 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
7125 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
7126 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007127
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02007128 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
7129 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
7130 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
7131 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
7132 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
7133 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007134
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01007135 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
7136 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007137
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007138 Example :
7139 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
7140 frontend www
7141 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
7142
7143 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
7144
7145
7146monitor-uri <uri>
7147 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7149 yes | yes | yes | no
7150 Arguments :
7151 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7152 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7153
7154 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7155 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7156 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7157 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7158 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7159 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7160 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7161 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7162
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007163 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007164 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7165 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7166 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7167 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7168 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7169 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007170
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007171 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7172 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7173 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7174 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7175
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007176 Example :
7177 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7178 frontend www
7179 mode http
7180 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7181
7182 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
7183
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007184
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007185option abortonclose
7186no option abortonclose
7187 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7189 yes | no | yes | yes
7190 Arguments : none
7191
7192 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7193 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7194 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7195 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007196 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007197 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7198 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7199 encountered while delivering the response.
7200
7201 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7202 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7203 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7204 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7205 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7206 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007207 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007208 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007209 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007210 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7211 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7212 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7213
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007214 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7215 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007216 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7217 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7218 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7219 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7220 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7221 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007222 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007223
7224 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7225 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7226
7227 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7228
7229
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007230option accept-invalid-http-request
7231no option accept-invalid-http-request
7232 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7234 yes | yes | yes | no
7235 Arguments : none
7236
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007237 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007238 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007239 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007240 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7241 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7242 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7243 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7244 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007245 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7246 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7247 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7248 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007249 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007250 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007251 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7252 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7253 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007254
7255 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7256 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7257 been confirmed.
7258
7259 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7260 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007261 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7262 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007263 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7264
7265 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7266 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7267
7268 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7269 stats socket.
7270
7271
7272option accept-invalid-http-response
7273no option accept-invalid-http-response
7274 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7276 yes | no | yes | yes
7277 Arguments : none
7278
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007279 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007280 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007281 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007282 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7283 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7284 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7285 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7286 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007287 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7288 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7289 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007290
7291 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7292 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7293 been confirmed.
7294
7295 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7296 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7297 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7298 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7299
7300 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7301 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7302
7303 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7304 stats socket.
7305
7306
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007307option allbackups
7308no option allbackups
7309 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7311 yes | no | yes | yes
7312 Arguments : none
7313
7314 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7315 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7316 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7317 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7318 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7319 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7320 order between the backup servers anymore.
7321
7322 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7323 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7324
7325 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7326 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7327
7328
7329option checkcache
7330no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007331 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7333 yes | no | yes | yes
7334 Arguments : none
7335
7336 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7337 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007338 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007339 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7340 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007341 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007342
7343 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007344 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007345 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007346 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7347 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007348 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007349 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007350 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7351 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007352 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007353 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7354 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007355 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007356 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7357 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7358 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7359 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7360 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7361 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7362 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7363 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7364 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7365
7366 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007367 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7368 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7369 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7370 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007371
7372 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7373 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007374 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007375 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007376
7377 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7378 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7379
7380
7381option clitcpka
7382no option clitcpka
7383 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7385 yes | yes | yes | no
7386 Arguments : none
7387
7388 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7389 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007390 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007391 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7392
7393 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7394 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7395 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7396 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7397
7398 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7399 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7400 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7401 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7402 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7403
7404 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7405
7406 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7407 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7408 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
7409
7410 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7411 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7412
7413 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
7414
7415
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007416option contstats
7417 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
7418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7419 yes | yes | yes | no
7420 Arguments : none
7421
7422 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
7423 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
7424 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
7425 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01007426 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
7427 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
7428 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
7429 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
7430 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007431
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02007432option disable-h2-upgrade
7433no option disable-h2-upgrade
7434 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
7435 connection.
7436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7437 yes | yes | yes | no
7438 Arguments : none
7439
7440 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
7441 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
7442 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
7443 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
7444 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be used to
7445 disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only supported
7446 for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to force the
7447 HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind line.
7448
7449 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7450 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007451
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007452option dontlog-normal
7453no option dontlog-normal
7454 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
7455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7456 yes | yes | yes | no
7457 Arguments : none
7458
7459 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
7460 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
7461 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
7462 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7463 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7464 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7465 logged.
7466
7467 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7468 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7469 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7470
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007471 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007472 logging.
7473
7474
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007475option dontlognull
7476no option dontlognull
7477 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7479 yes | yes | yes | no
7480 Arguments : none
7481
7482 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7483 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7484 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7485 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7486 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7487 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007488 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7489 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7490 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007491
7492 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007493 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007494 would not be logged.
7495
7496 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7497 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7498
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007499 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
7500 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007501
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007502
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007503option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007504 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7506 yes | yes | yes | yes
7507 Arguments :
7508 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7509 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007510 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007511 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007512
7513 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7514 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7515 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7516 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7517 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7518 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7519 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007520 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7521 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7522 possible that the client has already brought one.
7523
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007524 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007525 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007526 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007527 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007528 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007529 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007530
7531 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7532 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7533 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7534 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7535 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7536 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7537 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7538
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007539 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7540 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7541 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7542 are under the control of the end-user.
7543
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007544 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007545 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7546 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007547 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7548 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7549 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007550
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007551 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007552 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7553 frontend www
7554 mode http
7555 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7556
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007557 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7558 backend www
7559 mode http
7560 option forwardfor header X-Client
7561
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007562 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007563 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007564
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007565
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007566option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7567no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7568 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7570 yes | yes | yes | no
7571 Arguments : none
7572
7573 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7574 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7575 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7576 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7577 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7578 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7579 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7580
7581 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7582 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7583 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7584 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7585 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7586 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7587 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7588 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7589 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7590 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7591
7592 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7593
7594 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7595 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7596
7597 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7598 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7599
7600
7601option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7602no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7603 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7605 yes | no | yes | yes
7606 Arguments : none
7607
7608 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7609 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7610 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7611 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7612 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7613 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7614 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7615
7616 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7617 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7618 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7619 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7620 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7621 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7622 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7623 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7624 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7625 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7626
7627 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7628
7629 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7630 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7631
7632 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7633 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7634
7635
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007636option http-buffer-request
7637no option http-buffer-request
7638 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7640 yes | yes | yes | yes
7641 Arguments : none
7642
7643 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7644 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7645 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7646 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7647 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7648 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007649 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7650 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7651 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7652 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007653
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01007654 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007655
7656
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007657option http-ignore-probes
7658no option http-ignore-probes
7659 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
7660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7661 yes | yes | yes | no
7662 Arguments : none
7663
7664 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
7665 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
7666 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
7667 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
7668 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
7669 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
7670 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
7671 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
7672 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007673 was received over a connection before it was closed;
7674 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007675 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
7676
7677 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
7678 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
7679 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
7680 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
7681 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
7682 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
7683 are often the only way to detect them.
7684
7685 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7686 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7687
7688 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
7689
7690
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007691option http-keep-alive
7692no option http-keep-alive
7693 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
7694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7695 yes | yes | yes | yes
7696 Arguments : none
7697
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007698 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7699 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007700 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7701 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007702 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
7703 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
7704 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007705
7706 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
7707 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007708 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
7709 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
7710 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
7711 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
7712 situations where this option may be useful :
7713
7714 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007715 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007716
7717 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
7718 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
7719
7720 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
7721 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
7722 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
7723 request.
7724
7725 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
7726 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007727 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
7728 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
7729 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007730
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007731 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7732 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7733 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7734 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
7735 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7736 not set.
7737
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007738 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7739 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
7740 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007741
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007742 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007743 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01007744 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007745
7746
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007747option http-no-delay
7748no option http-no-delay
7749 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
7750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7751 yes | yes | yes | yes
7752 Arguments : none
7753
7754 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
7755 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
7756 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
7757 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
7758 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
7759 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
7760 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
7761 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
7762 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
7763 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
7764 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
7765 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
7766 affected.
7767
7768 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
7769 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
7770 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
7771 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
7772 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
7773 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
7774 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
7775 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
7776 latency environments.
7777
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007778 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7779
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007780
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007781option http-pretend-keepalive
7782no option http-pretend-keepalive
7783 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
7784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007785 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007786 Arguments : none
7787
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007788 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007789 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
7790 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
7791 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
7792 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
7793 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
7794 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
7795 consider the response complete.
7796
7797 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
7798 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
7799 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
7800 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007801 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007802 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
7803
7804 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
7805 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
7806 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
7807 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
7808 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
7809 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
7810 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
7811
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007812 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
7813 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
7814 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
7815 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
7816 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
7817 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007818
7819 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7820 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7821
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007822 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007823 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007824
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007825
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007826option http-server-close
7827no option http-server-close
7828 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
7829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7830 yes | yes | yes | yes
7831 Arguments : none
7832
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007833 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7834 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7835 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7836 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007837 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
7838 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
7839 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
7840 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
7841 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
7842 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7843 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7844 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7845 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7846 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7847 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007848
7849 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7850 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7851 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7852 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007853 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7854 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007855
7856 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7857 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007858 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7859 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7860 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007861
7862 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7863 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7864
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007865 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7866 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007867
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007868option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007869no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007870 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7872 yes | yes | yes | no
7873 Arguments : none
7874
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007875 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007876 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7877 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7878 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7879 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7880 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7881 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7882
7883 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7884 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007885 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7886 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7887 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007888
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007889 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7890 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7891 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7892 front of an existing proxy.
7893
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007894 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7895
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007896 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007897
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007898option httpchk
7899option httpchk <uri>
7900option httpchk <method> <uri>
7901option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007902 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7904 yes | no | yes | yes
7905 Arguments :
7906 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7907 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7908 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7909 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7910 ones.
7911
7912 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7913 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7914 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7915
7916 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7917 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7918 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007919 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007920
7921 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7922 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7923 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7924 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7925 the lack of any response.
7926
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007927 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
7928 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
7929 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
7930 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
7931
7932 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
7933 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
7934 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007935
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007936 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
7937 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007938 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007939 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007940 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007941
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007942 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
7943 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
7944 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
7945 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
7946
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007947 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007948 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
7949 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
7950 backend https_relay
7951 mode tcp
7952 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
7953 http-check send hdr Host www
7954 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007955
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09007956 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
7957 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
7958 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007959
7960
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007961option httpclose
7962no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007963 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7965 yes | yes | yes | yes
7966 Arguments : none
7967
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007968 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7969 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7970 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7971 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007972 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007973
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007974 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
7975 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05007976 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007977 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
7978 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007979
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007980 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
7981 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
7982 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007983
7984 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7985 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007986 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
7987 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7988 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007989
7990 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7991 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7992
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007993 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007994
7995
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007996option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007997 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
7998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007999 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008000 Arguments :
8001 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8002 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8003 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008004 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008005 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008006
8007 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8008 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8009 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8010 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8011 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8012 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8013 ports.
8014
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008015 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8016 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008017
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008018 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8019
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008020 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008021
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008022
8023option http_proxy
8024no option http_proxy
8025 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8027 yes | yes | yes | yes
8028 Arguments : none
8029
8030 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8031 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8032 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8033 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8034 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8035
8036 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8037 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008038 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8039 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008040
8041 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8042 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8043
8044 Example :
8045 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8046 backend direct_forward
8047 option httpclose
8048 option http_proxy
8049
8050 See also : "option httpclose"
8051
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008052
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008053option independent-streams
8054no option independent-streams
8055 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8057 yes | yes | yes | yes
8058 Arguments : none
8059
8060 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8061 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8062 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8063 receive data or not.
8064
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008065 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008066 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8067 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8068 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8069 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8070 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8071 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8072 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8073 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8074 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8075 socket buffers.
8076
8077 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8078 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8079 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8080 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8081 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8082
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008083 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008084
8085
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008086option ldap-check
8087 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8089 yes | no | yes | yes
8090 Arguments : none
8091
8092 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8093 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8094 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8095 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8096
8097 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8098 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8099
8100 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8101 configure it.
8102
8103 Example :
8104 option ldap-check
8105
8106 See also : "option httpchk"
8107
8108
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008109option external-check
8110 Use external processes for server health checks
8111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8112 yes | no | yes | yes
8113
8114 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8115 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8116 command".
8117
8118 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8119
8120 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8121
8122
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008123option log-health-checks
8124no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008125 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8127 yes | no | yes | yes
8128 Arguments : none
8129
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008130 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8131 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8132 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008133
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008134 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8135 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8136 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8137 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8138 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8139
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008140 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008141 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008142
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008143 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8144 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8145 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008146
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008147
8148option log-separate-errors
8149no option log-separate-errors
8150 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8152 yes | yes | yes | no
8153 Arguments : none
8154
8155 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8156 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8157 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8158 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8159 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8160 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8161 provides very important information.
8162
8163 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8164 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8165 error logs.
8166
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008167 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008168 logging.
8169
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008170
8171option logasap
8172no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008173 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8175 yes | yes | yes | no
8176 Arguments : none
8177
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008178 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8179 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8180 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8181 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8182
8183 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8184 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8185 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8186 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8187 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008188 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008189 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8190 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8191 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8192 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008193 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008194
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008195 Examples :
8196 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8197 mode http
8198 option httplog
8199 option logasap
8200 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8201
8202 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8203 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8204 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8205 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8206
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008207 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008208 logging.
8209
8210
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008211option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008212 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8214 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008215 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008216 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8217 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008218 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8219 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008220
8221 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8222 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008223 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008224 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8225 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8226 in the MySQL table, like this :
8227
8228 USE mysql;
8229 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8230 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8231
8232 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008233 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008234 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8235 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8236 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8237 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8238 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8239 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8240 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8241
8242 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8243 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008244
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008245 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008246
8247 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8248 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8249 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8250 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008251 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8252 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008253
8254 See also: "option httpchk"
8255
8256
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008257option nolinger
8258no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008259 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008260 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8261 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008262 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008263
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008264 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008265 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8266 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8267 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8268 connections.
8269
8270 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8271 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
8272 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
8273 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
8274 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
8275 this too.
8276
8277 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
8278 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
8279 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
8280
8281 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8282 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
8283 for servers.
8284
8285 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8286 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8287
8288
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008289option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8290 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8292 yes | yes | yes | yes
8293 Arguments :
8294 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8295 matching <network>
8296 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8297 header name.
8298
8299 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8300 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8301 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8302 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8303 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8304 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8305 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8306 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8307 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8308 possible that the client has already brought one.
8309
8310 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8311 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8312 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8313 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8314 header and requires different one.
8315
8316 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8317 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8318 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8319 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8320 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8321 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
8322 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
8323
8324 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8325 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8326 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8327 both are defined.
8328
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008329 Examples :
8330 # Original Destination address
8331 frontend www
8332 mode http
8333 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8334
8335 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8336 backend www
8337 mode http
8338 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8339
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008340 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008341
8342
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008343option persist
8344no option persist
8345 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8346 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8347 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008348 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008349
8350 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8351 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8352 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8353 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8354 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8355 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8356 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8357 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8358 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8359 redirected to another valid server.
8360
8361 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8362 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8363
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008364 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008365
8366
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008367option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8368 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8369 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8370 yes | no | yes | yes
8371 Arguments :
8372 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8373 PostgreSQL server.
8374
8375 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8376 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8377 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8378 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8379
8380 See also: "option httpchk"
8381
8382
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008383option prefer-last-server
8384no option prefer-last-server
8385 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
8386 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8387 yes | no | yes | yes
8388 Arguments : none
8389
8390 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
8391 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
8392 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
8393 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
8394 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
8395 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
8396 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
8397 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
8398 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008399 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
8400 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02008401 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
8402 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
8403 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008404 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
8405 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
8406 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008407
8408 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8409 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8410
8411 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
8412
8413
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008414option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008415option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008416no option redispatch
8417 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8418 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8419 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008420 Arguments :
8421 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
8422 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
8423 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008424 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008425 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008426 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008427 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
8428 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
8429 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
8430
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008431
8432 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8433 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8434 be able to access the service anymore.
8435
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01008436 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
8437 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008438
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02008439 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
8440 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
8441 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
8442 following order:
8443
8444 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
8445
8446 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
8447 list, or
8448
8449 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
8450
8451 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
8452 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
8453
8454 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
8455 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
8456 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
8457 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
8458
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008459 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008460 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8461 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008462
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008463 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8464 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8465
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008466 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008467
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008468
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008469option redis-check
8470 Use redis health checks for server testing
8471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8472 yes | no | yes | yes
8473 Arguments : none
8474
8475 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8476 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8477 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8478 find the "+PONG" response message.
8479
8480 Example :
8481 option redis-check
8482
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008483 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008484
8485
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008486option smtpchk
8487option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8488 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8490 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008491 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008492 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008493 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008494 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8495
8496 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8497 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8498 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8499
8500 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8501 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8502 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8503 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8504 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8505 dead server.
8506
8507 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8508 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008509 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008510 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8511
8512 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8513 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8514 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8515 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008516 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008517
8518 Example :
8519 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8520
8521 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8522
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008523
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008524option socket-stats
8525no option socket-stats
8526
8527 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8529 yes | yes | yes | no
8530
8531 Arguments : none
8532
8533
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008534option splice-auto
8535no option splice-auto
8536 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8538 yes | yes | yes | yes
8539 Arguments : none
8540
8541 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8542 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008543 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008544 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008545 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008546 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8547 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8548 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8549 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8550
8551 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8552 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8553 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8554 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8555 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8556 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8557 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8558 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8559 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8560 keyword.
8561
8562 Example :
8563 option splice-auto
8564
8565 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8566 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8567
8568 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8569 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8570
8571
8572option splice-request
8573no option splice-request
8574 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8576 yes | yes | yes | yes
8577 Arguments : none
8578
8579 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008580 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008581 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8582 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8583 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8584 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8585
8586 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8587
8588 Example :
8589 option splice-request
8590
8591 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8592 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8593
8594 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8595 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8596
8597
8598option splice-response
8599no option splice-response
8600 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8602 yes | yes | yes | yes
8603 Arguments : none
8604
8605 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008606 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008607 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8608 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8609 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8610 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8611
8612 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8613
8614 Example :
8615 option splice-response
8616
8617 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8618 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8619
8620 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8621 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8622
8623
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008624option spop-check
8625 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8627 no | no | no | yes
8628 Arguments : none
8629
8630 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8631 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8632 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8633 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8634
8635 Example :
8636 option spop-check
8637
8638 See also : "option httpchk"
8639
8640
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008641option srvtcpka
8642no option srvtcpka
8643 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
8644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8645 yes | no | yes | yes
8646 Arguments : none
8647
8648 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8649 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008650 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008651 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8652
8653 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8654 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8655 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8656 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8657
8658 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8659 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8660 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8661 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8662 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8663
8664 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8665
8666 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8667 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8668 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
8669
8670 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8671 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8672
8673 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
8674
8675
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008676option ssl-hello-chk
8677 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
8678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8679 yes | no | yes | yes
8680 Arguments : none
8681
8682 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
8683 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
8684 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
8685 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
8686 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
8687 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
8688 hello message.
8689
8690 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
8691 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
8692 messages, which is appreciable.
8693
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008694 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
8695 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
8696 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008697
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008698 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
8699
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008700
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008701option tcp-check
8702 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
8703 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8704 yes | no | yes | yes
8705
8706 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
8707 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
8708
8709 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
8710 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
8711 attempt, which remains the default mode.
8712
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008713 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008714 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
8715 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
8716 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
8717 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
8718 only.
8719
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008720 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008721 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
8722 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
8723 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
8724 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
8725
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008726 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008727 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
8728 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008729 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008730 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
8731 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
8732 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
8733 the respective protocols.
8734 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008735 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008736
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008737 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008738
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008739 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
8740 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
8741 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
8742 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008743
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008744 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
8745 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
8746 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01008747
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008748
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008749 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008750 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008751 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008752 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008753
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008754 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008755 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008756 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008757
8758 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
8759 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008760 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008761 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008762 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008763 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008764 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008765 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008766 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8767 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008768 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008769 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8770 tcp-check expect string +OK
8771
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008772 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008773 (send many headers before analyzing)
8774 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008775 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008776 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
8777 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
8778 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
8779 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008780 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008781
8782
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008783 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008784
8785
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008786option tcp-smart-accept
8787no option tcp-smart-accept
8788 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
8789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8790 yes | yes | yes | no
8791 Arguments : none
8792
8793 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
8794 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
8795 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
8796 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
8797 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
8798 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
8799
8800 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
8801 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
8802 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
8803 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
8804
8805 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
8806 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
8807 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008808 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008809
8810 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
8811 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
8812 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
8813
8814 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
8815 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
8816 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
8817
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02008818 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
8819
8820
8821option tcp-smart-connect
8822no option tcp-smart-connect
8823 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
8824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8825 yes | no | yes | yes
8826 Arguments : none
8827
8828 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
8829 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
8830 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
8831 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
8832 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
8833
8834 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
8835 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
8836 complex.
8837
8838 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
8839 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
8840 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
8841
8842 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8843 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8844
8845 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
8846
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008847
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008848option tcpka
8849 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
8850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8851 yes | yes | yes | yes
8852 Arguments : none
8853
8854 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8855 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008856 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008857 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8858
8859 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8860 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8861 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8862 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8863
8864 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8865 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8866 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8867 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8868 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8869
8870 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8871
8872 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
8873 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
8874 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
8875 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
8876 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
8877 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
8878 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
8879 backends.
8880
8881 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
8882
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008883
8884option tcplog
8885 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
8886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008887 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008888 Arguments : none
8889
8890 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8891 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8892 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8893 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8894 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8895 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8896 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8897 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8898
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008899 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8900
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008901 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008902
8903
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008904option transparent
8905no option transparent
8906 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008908 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008909 Arguments : none
8910
8911 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8912 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8913 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8914 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8915 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8916 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8917 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8918 appropriate server.
8919
8920 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8921 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8922
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008923 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008924 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008925
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008926
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008927external-check command <command>
8928 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8929 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8930 yes | no | yes | yes
8931
8932 Arguments :
8933 <command> is the external command to run
8934
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008935 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8936
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008937 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008938
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008939 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
8940 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
8941 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
8942 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
8943 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
8944 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008945
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01008946 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
8947
8948 Environment variables :
8949 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
8950 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
8951
8952 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
8953
8954 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
8955
8956 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
8957 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
8958 for a UNIX socket).
8959
8960 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
8961
8962 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
8963
8964 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
8965
8966 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
8967
8968 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
8969
8970 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
8971 socket).
8972
8973 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
8974 the command may be set using "external-check path".
8975
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02008976 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
8977
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008978 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
8979 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
8980 failed.
8981
8982 Example :
8983 external-check command /bin/true
8984
8985 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
8986
8987
8988external-check path <path>
8989 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
8990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8991 yes | no | yes | yes
8992
8993 Arguments :
8994 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
8995
8996 The default path is "".
8997
8998 Example :
8999 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9000
9001 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9002 "external-check command"
9003
9004
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009005persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009006persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009007 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9008 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9009 yes | no | yes | yes
9010 Arguments :
9011 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009012 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9013 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009014
9015 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9016 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009017 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009018 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9019 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9020 forwarded to this server.
9021
9022 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9023 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9024 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009025 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009026 a single "listen" section.
9027
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009028 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9029 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9030 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9031
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009032 Example :
9033 listen tse-farm
9034 bind :3389
9035 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9036 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9037 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9038 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9039 persist rdp-cookie
9040 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009041 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009042 balance rdp-cookie
9043 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9044 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9045
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009046 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9047 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009048
9049
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009050rate-limit sessions <rate>
9051 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9053 yes | yes | yes | no
9054 Arguments :
9055 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9056 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9057
9058 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9059 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9060 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9061 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9062 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9063 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9064
9065 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9066 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9067 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9068 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9069
9070 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9071 listen smtp
9072 mode tcp
9073 bind :25
9074 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009075 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009076
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009077 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9078 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9079 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009080
9081 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9082
9083
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009084redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9085redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9086redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009087 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9089 no | yes | yes | yes
9090
9091 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009092 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009093
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009094 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009095 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009096 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9097 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9098 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009099
9100 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9101 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9102 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9103 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9104 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009105 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9106 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9107 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9108 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009109
9110 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9111 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9112 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9113 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9114 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9115 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009116 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009117 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009118 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9119 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9120 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009121
9122 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009123 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9124 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9125 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009126 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009127 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9128 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9129 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9130 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009131
9132 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009133 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009134
9135 - "drop-query"
9136 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9137 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9138 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9139 with a location-type redirect.
9140
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009141 - "append-slash"
9142 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9143 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9144 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9145 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9146
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009147 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9148 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9149 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9150 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9151 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9152 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9153 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9154
9155 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9156 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9157 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9158 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9159 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9160 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9161 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009162
9163 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9164 acl clear dst_port 80
9165 acl secure dst_port 8080
9166 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009167 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009168 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009169 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9170
9171 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009172 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9173 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9174 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009175 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009176
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009177 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9178 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9179 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9180
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009181 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009182 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009183
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009184 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02009185 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9186 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9187 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009188
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009189 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009190
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009191
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009192retries <value>
9193 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
9194 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9195 yes | no | yes | yes
9196 Arguments :
9197 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9198 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9199 default value is 3.
9200
9201 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9202 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9203 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9204
9205 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009206 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9207 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009208
9209 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9210 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9211
9212 See also : "option redispatch"
9213
9214
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009215retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009216 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9217 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9218 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009219 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9220 yes | no | yes | yes
9221 Arguments :
9222 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9223 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9224 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9225 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9226
9227 none never retry
9228
9229 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9230 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9231
9232 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9233 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9234 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9235 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9236 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9237 processing the request.
9238
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009239 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9240 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9241 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9242 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9243 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9244 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9245 overflow attack for example).
9246
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009247 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9248 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9249 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9250 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9251 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9252 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9253 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9254 amplify denial of service attacks.
9255
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009256 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9257 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9258 considered to be safe to retry.
9259
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009260 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
9261 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
9262 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
9263 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
9264
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009265 all-retryable-errors
9266 retry request for any error that are considered
9267 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9268 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9269 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9270
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009271 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9272 not cumulative.
9273
9274 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9275 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9276 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9277 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9278
9279 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9280 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9281 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9282 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9283 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9284 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9285 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9286 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9287 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9288 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9289 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9290 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9291
9292 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9293 should not use this directive.
9294
9295 The default is "conn-failure".
9296
9297 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9298
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009299server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009300 Declare a server in a backend
9301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9302 no | no | yes | yes
9303 Arguments :
9304 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009305 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009306 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009307
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009308 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9309 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9310 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9311 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009312 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9313 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9314 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9315 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9316 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009317 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9318 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9319 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9320 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9321 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9322 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9323 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009324 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009325 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9326 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9327 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9328 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9329 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9330 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009331 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9332 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009333 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9334 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009335
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009336 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009337 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9338 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9339 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9340 adding this value to the client's port.
9341
9342 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9343 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009344 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009345
9346 Examples :
9347 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9348 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009349 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009350 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9351 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9352 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009353
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009354 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9355 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9356 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9357 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9358 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9359
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009360 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9361 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009362
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009363server-state-file-name [<file>]
9364 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
9365 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
9366 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
9367 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
9368 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
9369 global directive "server-state-file-base".
9370
9371 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9372 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9373
9374 global
9375 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9376
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009377 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009378 load-server-state-from-file
9379
9380 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
9381 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009382
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02009383server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
9384 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
9385 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
9386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9387 no | no | yes | yes
9388
9389 Arguments:
9390 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
9391
9392 <num | range>
9393 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
9394 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
9395 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
9396 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
9397
9398 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
9399
9400 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
9401
9402 <params*>
9403 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
9404 keyword.
9405
9406 Examples:
9407 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
9408 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
9409 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
9410
9411 # or
9412 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
9413
9414 # would be equivalent to:
9415 server srv1 google.com:80 check
9416 server srv2 google.com:80 check
9417 server srv3 google.com:80 check
9418
9419
9420
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009421source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009422source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009423source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009424 Set the source address for outgoing connections
9425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9426 yes | no | yes | yes
9427 Arguments :
9428 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
9429 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009430
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009431 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009432 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
9433 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
9434 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
9435 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
9436 supported prefixes are :
9437 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9438 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9439 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009440 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02009441 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9442 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009443
9444 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
9445 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009446 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
9447 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
9448 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009449
9450 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
9451 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
9452 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
9453 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
9454 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
9455 <addr>.
9456
9457 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
9458 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
9459 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
9460 port.
9461
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009462 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
9463 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9464 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9465 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009466 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009467 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9468 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9469 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9470 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9471 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9472 HTTP header.
9473
9474 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9475 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009476 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009477 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9478 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9479 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9480 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9481 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9482 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9483 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9484
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009485 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9486 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9487 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9488 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9489 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9490 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9491
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009492 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9493 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9494 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9495 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9496
9497 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9498 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9499 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9500 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9501 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9502 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9503
9504 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9505 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9506 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9507 there are two methods :
9508
9509 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9510 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9511 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9512 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9513 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9514 of the client ranges may be used.
9515
9516 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9517 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9518 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9519 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9520 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9521 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9522 same session.
9523
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009524 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9525 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9526 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009527 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009528
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009529 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9530
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009531 Examples :
9532 backend private
9533 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9534 source 192.168.1.200
9535
9536 backend transparent_ssl1
9537 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9538 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9539
9540 backend transparent_ssl2
9541 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9542 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9543 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9544
9545 backend transparent_ssl3
9546 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9547 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9548 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9549
9550 backend transparent_smtp
9551 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9552 # with Tproxy version 4.
9553 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9554
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009555 backend transparent_http
9556 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9557 # proxy.
9558 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9559
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009560 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009561 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9562
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009563
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009564srvtcpka-cnt <count>
9565 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
9566 the connection on the server side.
9567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9568 yes | no | yes | yes
9569 Arguments :
9570 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
9571
9572 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
9573 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009574 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9575 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009576
9577 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9578
9579
9580srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
9581 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
9582 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
9583 server side.
9584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9585 yes | no | yes | yes
9586 Arguments :
9587 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
9588 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
9589 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
9590 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
9591
9592 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
9593 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009594 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9595 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009596
9597 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9598
9599
9600srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
9601 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
9602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9603 yes | no | yes | yes
9604 Arguments :
9605 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
9606 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
9607 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
9608 document.
9609
9610 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
9611 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009612 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9613 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009614
9615 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
9616
9617
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009618stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9619 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009621 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009622
9623 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9624 matched.
9625
9626 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9627 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9628
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009629 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9630 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009631 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009632
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009633 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9634 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9635 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9636 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009637
9638 Example :
9639 # statistics admin level only for localhost
9640 backend stats_localhost
9641 stats enable
9642 stats admin if LOCALHOST
9643
9644 Example :
9645 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
9646 backend stats_auth
9647 stats enable
9648 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
9649 stats admin if TRUE
9650
9651 Example :
9652 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
9653 userlist stats-auth
9654 group admin users admin
9655 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
9656 group readonly users haproxy
9657 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
9658
9659 backend stats_auth
9660 stats enable
9661 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
9662 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
9663 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
9664 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
9665
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009666 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
9667 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
9668 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009669
9670
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009671stats auth <user>:<passwd>
9672 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
9673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009674 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009675 Arguments :
9676 <user> is a user name to grant access to
9677
9678 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
9679
9680 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
9681 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
9682 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
9683 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
9684 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
9685 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
9686
9687 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
9688 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
9689 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009690 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009691
9692 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
9693 report using "stats scope".
9694
9695 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9696 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9697 unobvious parameters.
9698
9699 Example :
9700 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9701 backend public_www
9702 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9703 stats enable
9704 stats hide-version
9705 stats scope .
9706 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009707 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009708 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9709 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9710
9711 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9712 backend private_monitoring
9713 stats enable
9714 stats uri /admin?stats
9715 stats refresh 5s
9716
9717 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
9718
9719
9720stats enable
9721 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
9722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009723 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009724 Arguments : none
9725
9726 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
9727 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
9728 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
9729 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
9730 - stats auth : no authentication
9731 - stats scope : no restriction
9732
9733 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9734 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9735 unobvious parameters.
9736
9737 Example :
9738 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9739 backend public_www
9740 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9741 stats enable
9742 stats hide-version
9743 stats scope .
9744 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009745 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009746 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9747 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9748
9749 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9750 backend private_monitoring
9751 stats enable
9752 stats uri /admin?stats
9753 stats refresh 5s
9754
9755 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9756
9757
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009758stats hide-version
9759 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009761 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009762 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009763
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009764 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
9765 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
9766 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
9767 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
9768 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
9769 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009770
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009771 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9772 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9773 unobvious parameters.
9774
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009775 Example :
9776 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9777 backend public_www
9778 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009779 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009780 stats hide-version
9781 stats scope .
9782 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009783 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009784 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9785 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009786
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009787 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9788 backend private_monitoring
9789 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009790 stats uri /admin?stats
9791 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01009792
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009793 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009794
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009795
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02009796stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
9797 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
9798 Access control for statistics
9799
9800 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9801 no | no | yes | yes
9802
9803 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
9804 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
9805 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
9806 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
9807 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9808 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9809
9810 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9811 instance.
9812
9813 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9814 about ACL usage.
9815
9816
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009817stats realm <realm>
9818 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009820 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009821 Arguments :
9822 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9823 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9824 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9825
9826 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9827 using a backslash ('\').
9828
9829 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9830 only related to authentication.
9831
9832 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9833 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9834 unobvious parameters.
9835
9836 Example :
9837 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9838 backend public_www
9839 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9840 stats enable
9841 stats hide-version
9842 stats scope .
9843 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009844 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009845 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9846 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9847
9848 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9849 backend private_monitoring
9850 stats enable
9851 stats uri /admin?stats
9852 stats refresh 5s
9853
9854 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9855
9856
9857stats refresh <delay>
9858 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009860 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009861 Arguments :
9862 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9863 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9864 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9865 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9866 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9867 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9868
9869 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9870 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9871 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -05009872 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009873
9874 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9875 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9876 unobvious parameters.
9877
9878 Example :
9879 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9880 backend public_www
9881 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9882 stats enable
9883 stats hide-version
9884 stats scope .
9885 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009886 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009887 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9888 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9889
9890 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9891 backend private_monitoring
9892 stats enable
9893 stats uri /admin?stats
9894 stats refresh 5s
9895
9896 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9897
9898
9899stats scope { <name> | "." }
9900 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9901 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009902 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009903 Arguments :
9904 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9905 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9906 section in which the statement appears.
9907
9908 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9909 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9910 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9911 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9912 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9913 exists.
9914
9915 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9916 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9917 unobvious parameters.
9918
9919 Example :
9920 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9921 backend public_www
9922 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9923 stats enable
9924 stats hide-version
9925 stats scope .
9926 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009927 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009928 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9929 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9930
9931 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9932 backend private_monitoring
9933 stats enable
9934 stats uri /admin?stats
9935 stats refresh 5s
9936
9937 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9938
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009939
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009940stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009941 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009943 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009944
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009945 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009946 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9947
9948 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9949 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9950
9951 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9952 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009953 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009954
9955 Example :
9956 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9957 backend private_monitoring
9958 stats enable
9959 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9960 stats uri /admin?stats
9961 stats refresh 5s
9962
9963 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9964 global section.
9965
9966
9967stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009968 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9970 yes | yes | yes | yes
9971 Arguments : none
9972
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009973 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009974 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9975 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9976 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9977 - IP (socket, server)
9978 - cookie (backend, server)
9979
9980 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9981 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009982 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009983
9984 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9985
9986
9987stats show-node [ <name> ]
9988 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009990 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009991 Arguments:
9992 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9993 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9994
9995 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9996 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009997 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009998
9999 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10000 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10001 unobvious parameters.
10002
10003 Example:
10004 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10005 backend private_monitoring
10006 stats enable
10007 stats show-node Europe-1
10008 stats uri /admin?stats
10009 stats refresh 5s
10010
10011 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10012 section.
10013
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010014
10015stats uri <prefix>
10016 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010018 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010019 Arguments :
10020 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10021 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10022 query string.
10023
10024 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10025 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10026 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10027 possible to reach it in the application.
10028
10029 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010030 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010031 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10032 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10033 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10034 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10035
10036 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10037 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10038 an address or a port to statistics only.
10039
10040 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10041 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10042 unobvious parameters.
10043
10044 Example :
10045 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10046 backend public_www
10047 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10048 stats enable
10049 stats hide-version
10050 stats scope .
10051 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010052 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010053 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10054 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10055
10056 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10057 backend private_monitoring
10058 stats enable
10059 stats uri /admin?stats
10060 stats refresh 5s
10061
10062 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10063
10064
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010065stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10066 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010068 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010069
10070 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010071 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010072 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010073 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010074 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10075
10076 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10077 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10078 the "stick-table" statement.
10079
10080 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10081 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10082 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10083 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10084 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10085
10086 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10087 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10088 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10089 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10090 transformation rules.
10091
10092 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10093 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10094 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10095 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10096 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10097 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10098 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10099
10100 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10101 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10102 ACL based conditions.
10103
10104 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10105 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10106 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10107 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10108
10109 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10110 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10111 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10112 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10113
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010114 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10115 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010116 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010117
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010118 Example :
10119 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10120 # last 30 minutes
10121 backend pop
10122 mode tcp
10123 balance roundrobin
10124 stick store-request src
10125 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10126 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10127 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10128
10129 backend smtp
10130 mode tcp
10131 balance roundrobin
10132 stick match src table pop
10133 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10134 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10135
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010136 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010137 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010138
10139
10140stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10141 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10143 no | no | yes | yes
10144
10145 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10146 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10147 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10148 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10149
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010150 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10151 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010152 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010153
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010154 Examples :
10155 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010010156 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010157
10158 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
10159 stick match src table pop if !localhost
10160 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
10161
10162
10163 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
10164 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
10165 backend http
10166 mode http
10167 balance roundrobin
10168 stick on src table https
10169 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
10170 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
10171 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
10172
10173 backend https
10174 mode tcp
10175 balance roundrobin
10176 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10177 stick on src
10178 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10179 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10180
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010181 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010182
10183
10184stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10185 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
10186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10187 no | no | yes | yes
10188
10189 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010190 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010191 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010192 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010193 server is selected.
10194
10195 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10196 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10197 the "stick-table" statement.
10198
10199 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10200 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10201 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
10202 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
10203 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
10204 address.
10205
10206 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10207 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
10208 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
10209 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
10210 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
10211 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
10212 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
10213 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
10214 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
10215 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
10216
10217 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10218 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10219 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10220 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10221 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10222 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10223 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10224
10225 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
10226 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10227 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
10228 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10229
10230 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
10231 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10232 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10233 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10234 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10235 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010236 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
10237 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10238 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10239 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10240 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10241 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010242
10243 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
10244 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
10245 the request.
10246
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010247 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10248 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010249 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010250
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010251 Example :
10252 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10253 # last 30 minutes
10254 backend pop
10255 mode tcp
10256 balance roundrobin
10257 stick store-request src
10258 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10259 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10260 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10261
10262 backend smtp
10263 mode tcp
10264 balance roundrobin
10265 stick match src table pop
10266 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10267 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10268
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010269 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010270 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010271
10272
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010273stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010274 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
10275 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010276 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010278 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010279
10280 Arguments :
10281 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10282 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10283 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10284 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10285
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010286 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10287 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10288 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10289 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10290
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010291 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10292 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10293 instance.
10294
10295 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10296 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10297 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10298 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10299 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10300 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010301 to 32 characters.
10302
10303 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10304 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10305 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010306 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010307 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10308 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010309
10310 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010311 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10312 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010313 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10314 increase.
10315
10316 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010317 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10318 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10319 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010320
10321 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10322 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10323 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10324 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010325 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010326 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10327 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10328 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10329 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10330 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10331 parameter (see below).
10332
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010333 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10334 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10335 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10336 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10337 soft restart.
10338
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010339 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10340 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010341
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010342 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10343 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10344 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10345 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010346 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010347 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010348 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10349 if not expiration delay is specified.
10350
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010351 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10352 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10353 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10354 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010355 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
10356 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
10357 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
10358 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
10359 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
10360 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
10361 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
10362 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
10363 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
10364 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
10365 types and their arguments.
10366
10367 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
10368 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
10369 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
10370 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
10371
10372 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10373 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10374 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010375 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010376
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010377 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10378 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10379 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010380 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010381 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010382 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010383
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010384 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10385 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10386 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
10387 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
10388
10389 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
10390 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10391 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
10392 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
10393 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
10394 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
10395
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010396 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10397 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
10398 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
10399 they were received.
10400
10401 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10402 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
10403 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
10404 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
10405 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
10406
10407 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10408 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10409 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10410 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
10411 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10412
10413 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10414 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
10415 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
10416
10417 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10418 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10419 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10420 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
10421 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10422
10423 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10424 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
10425 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
10426 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
10427 the client side.
10428
10429 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10430 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10431 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10432 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
10433 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
10434 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
10435 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
10436
10437 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10438 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
10439 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10440 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
10441 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
10442 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010443 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010444
10445 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10446 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10447 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10448 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10449 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
10450 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10451
10452 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010453 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010454 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
10455 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
10456
10457 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10458 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10459 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10460 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10461 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10462 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
10463 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
10464 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
10465 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
10466 recommended for better fairness.
10467
10468 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010469 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010470 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
10471 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
10472
10473 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10474 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10475 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10476 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10477 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10478 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
10479 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
10480 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
10481 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
10482 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010483
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010484 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
10485 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010486 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
10487 reference it.
10488
10489 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
10490 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010010491 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
10492 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
10493 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010494
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010495 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
10496 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
10497 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
10498 something that can be ignored.
10499
10500 Example:
10501 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
10502 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
10503 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
10504 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
10505
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010506 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010010507 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010508
10509
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010510stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010010511 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10513 no | no | yes | yes
10514
10515 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010516 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010517 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010518 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010519 server is selected.
10520
10521 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10522 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10523 the "stick-table" statement.
10524
10525 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10526 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10527 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
10528 when the response is a SSL server hello.
10529
10530 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10531 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
10532 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
10533 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
10534 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
10535 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010536 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010537 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
10538 rules.
10539
10540 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10541 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10542 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10543 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10544 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10545 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10546 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10547
10548 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
10549 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10550 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
10551 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10552
10553 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
10554 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10555 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10556 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10557 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10558 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010559 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
10560 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10561 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10562 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10563 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10564 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
10565 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
10566 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
10567 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010568
10569 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
10570
10571 Example :
10572 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
10573 backend https
10574 mode tcp
10575 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010576 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010577 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010578
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010579 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
10580 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
10581
10582 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
10583 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10584 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
10585
10586 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
10587 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010588
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010589 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
10590 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
10591 # at offset 44.
10592
10593 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10594 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10595
10596 # Learn on response if server hello.
10597 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010598
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010599 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10600 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10601
10602 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
10603 extraction.
10604
10605
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010606tcp-check comment <string>
10607 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
10608 it fails.
10609 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10610 yes | no | yes | yes
10611
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010612 Arguments :
10613 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
10614 rule fails.
10615
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010616 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
10617 user-friendly error reporting.
10618
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010619 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
10620 "tcp-check expect".
10621
10622
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010623tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
10624 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010625 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010626 Opens a new connection
10627 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010628 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010629
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010630 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010631 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10632
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010633 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040010634 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010635
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010636 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010637 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
10638 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010639 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010640
10641 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010642
10643 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
10644
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020010645 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
10646
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010647 ssl opens a ciphered connection
10648
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020010649 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
10650
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020010651 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
10652 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
10653 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10654 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
10655
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010656 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
10657 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
10658 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
10659 haproxy -vv.
10660
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010661 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010662
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010663 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
10664 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
10665 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
10666
10667 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
10668 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
10669 of the sequence.
10670
10671 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
10672 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
10673 do.
10674
10675 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
10676 unset-var or comment rules.
10677
10678 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010679 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
10680 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
10681 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
10682 option tcp-check
10683 tcp-check connect
10684 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10685 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10686 tcp-check send \r\n
10687 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10688 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
10689 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10690 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10691 tcp-check send \r\n
10692 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10693 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
10694
10695 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
10696 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010697 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010698 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10699 tcp-check connect port 143
10700 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10701 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
10702
10703 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
10704
10705
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010706tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010707 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010708 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010709 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010710 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010711 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010712 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010713
10714 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010715 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10716
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010717 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
10718 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
10719 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
10720 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
10721 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
10722 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
10723 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
10724 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
10725 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
10726 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
10727
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010728 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010729 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
10730 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010731 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
10732 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
10733 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
10734
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010735 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10736 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
10737 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010738 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
10739 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
10740 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
10741 example 404 with disable-on-404
10742 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
10743 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010744 By default "L7OK" is used.
10745
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010746 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10747 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010748 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
10749 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10750 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
10751 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10752 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
10753 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010754
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010755 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010756 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010757 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
10758 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10759 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10760 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010761 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
10762
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020010763 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10764 informational message reported in logs if the expect
10765 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
10766 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
10767
10768 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10769 informational message reported in logs if an error
10770 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
10771 log-format string.
10772
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010773 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
10774 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
10775 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10776 followed by some converters.
10777
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010778 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
10779 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
10780 with the usual backslash ('\').
10781 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010782 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010783 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
10784 used upper or lower case.
10785
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010786 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
10787
10788 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
10789 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10790 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
10791 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10792 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
10793 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
10794 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
10795 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
10796
10797 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
10798 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10799 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
10800 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10801 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
10802 expression.
10803
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010804 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
10805 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10806 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
10807 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
10808 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10809 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
10810
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010811 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
10812 in the response buffer. A health check response will
10813 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
10814 this exact hexadecimal string.
10815 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
10816
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010817 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
10818 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
10819 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
10820 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
10821 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
10822 size of the original response. As such, the expected
10823 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
10824 size.
10825
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010826 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
10827 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
10828 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
10829 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
10830 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
10831 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10832 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
10833 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
10834 in a binary string before matching the response's
10835 buffer.
10836
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010837 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
10838 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
10839 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
10840 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
10841 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
10842 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
10843 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
10844 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
10845 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
10846 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
10847 the null character.
10848
10849 Examples :
10850 # perform a POP check
10851 option tcp-check
10852 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10853
10854 # perform an IMAP check
10855 option tcp-check
10856 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10857
10858 # look for the redis master server
10859 option tcp-check
10860 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010861 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010862 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10863 tcp-check expect string role:master
10864 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10865 tcp-check expect string +OK
10866
10867
10868 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
10869 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
10870
10871
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010872tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
10873tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
10874 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
10875 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010876 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010877 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010878
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010879 Arguments :
10880 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10881
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010882 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
10883 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010884
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010885 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
10886 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010887
10888 Examples :
10889 # look for the redis master server
10890 option tcp-check
10891 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10892 tcp-check expect string role:master
10893
10894 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10895 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
10896
10897
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010898tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
10899tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
10900 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
10901 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010902 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010903 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010904
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010905 Arguments :
10906 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010907
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010908 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
10909 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010910
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010911 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
10912 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
10913 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010914
10915 Examples :
10916 # redis check in binary
10917 option tcp-check
10918 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
10919 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
10920
10921
10922 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10923 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
10924
10925
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010926tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010927 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010928 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010929 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010930
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010931 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010932 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10933 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10934 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10935 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10936 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10937 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10938 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10939 and '-'.
10940
10941 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
10942
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010943 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010944 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
10945
10946
10947tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010948 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010949 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010950 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010951
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010952 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010953 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10954 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10955 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10956 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10957 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10958 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10959 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10960 and '-'.
10961
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010962 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010963 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
10964
10965
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010966tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10967 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10969 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010970 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010971 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10972 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010973
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010974 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010975
10976 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
10977 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010978 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
10979 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
10980 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
10981 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
10982 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
10983 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010984
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010985 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10986 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10987 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
10988 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010989
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010990 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010991 - accept :
10992 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10993 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10994 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010995
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010996 - reject :
10997 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10998 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10999 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11000 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11001 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11002 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11003 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11004 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11005 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11006 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11007 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011008 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011009
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011010 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11011 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11012 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11013 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11014 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11015 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11016 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11017 hosts.
11018
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011019 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11020 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11021 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11022 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11023 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11024 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11025 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11026 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11027
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011028 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11029 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11030 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11031 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11032 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11033 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11034 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11035 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11036 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011037 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11038 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011039
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011040 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011041 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011042 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11043 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11044 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011045 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011046 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
11047 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11048 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11049 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11050 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11051 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11052 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11053 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011054
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011055 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011056 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011057 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011058 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011059 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11060 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11061 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011062
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011063 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11064 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11065 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11066 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011067
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011068 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11069 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11070 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11071 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11072 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011073 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11074 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11075 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11076 layer7 information is extracted.
11077
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011078 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11079 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11080 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11081 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11082 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011083
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011084 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11085 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11086 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11087 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11088
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011089 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11090 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11091 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11092 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11093
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011094 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11095 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11096 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11097 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11098 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011099
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011100 - set-src <expr> :
11101 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11102 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11103 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011104 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011105
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011106 Arguments:
11107 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11108 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011109
11110 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011111 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
11112
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011113 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
11114 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011115
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011116 - set-src-port <expr> :
11117 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
11118 expression.
11119
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011120 Arguments:
11121 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11122 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011123
11124 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011125 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
11126
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011127 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
11128 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
11129 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011130
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011131 - set-dst <expr> :
11132 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
11133 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
11134 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
11135 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11136 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11137
11138 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11139 followed by some converters.
11140
11141 Example:
11142
11143 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
11144 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
11145
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011146 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
11147 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
11148
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011149 - set-dst-port <expr> :
11150 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
11151 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11152 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11153
11154
11155 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11156 followed by some converters.
11157
11158 Example:
11159
11160 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
11161
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011162 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
11163 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
11164 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
11165
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011166 - "silent-drop" :
11167 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011168 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011169 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11170 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11171 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11172 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11173 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011174 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11175 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011176 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11177 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011178 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011179 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11180 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11181 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11182 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11183
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011184 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11185 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11186 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011187
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011188 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11189 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
11190 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011191
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011192 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011193 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011194 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011195
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011196 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
11197 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11198 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011199
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011200 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011201 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11202 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011203
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011204 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
11205
11206 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11207
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011208 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11209
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011210 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011211
11212
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011213tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11214 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011216 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011217 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011218 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11219 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011220
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011221 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011222
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011223 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011224 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11225 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
11226 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
11227 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011228
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011229 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
11230 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
11231 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
11232 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011233 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
11234 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
11235 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
11236 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
11237 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
11238 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011239 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011240 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011241
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011242 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11243 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11244 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11245 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011246
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011247 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011248 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011249 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011250 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11251 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011252 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011253 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011254 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011255 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011256 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011257 - set-dst <expr>
11258 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011259 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011260 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011261 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011262 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011263 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011264
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011265 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11266 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011267 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11268 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011269
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011270 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11271 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11272 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11273 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11274 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11275 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011276
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011277 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011278 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11279 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011280
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011281 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011282 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
11283 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
11284 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
11285 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011286 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
11287 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
11288 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011289
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011290 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011291 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11292 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11293 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011294
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011295 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
11296 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
11297
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011298 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011299 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
11300 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011301
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011302 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11303 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011304 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011305 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11306 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011307 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011308 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011309 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011310 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11311 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011312 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011313 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11314 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011315
11316 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11317 followed by some converters.
11318
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011319 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11320 <var-name>.
11321
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011322 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
11323 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
11324 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
11325 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
11326 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
11327
11328 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
11329 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
11330 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
11331 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
11332 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
11333 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
11334 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
11335 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
11336 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
11337 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
11338 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
11339
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011340 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11341 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11342 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11343 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11344 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11345
11346 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11347
11348 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11349
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011350 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
11351 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
11352 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
11353 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
11354 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
11355 evaluated.
11356
11357 Example:
11358 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
11359
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011360 Example:
11361
11362 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011363 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011364
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011365 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011366 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
11367 # and reject everything else.
11368 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
11369 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011370 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011371 tcp-request content reject
11372
11373 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011374 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
11375 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11376 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011377 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011378
11379 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
11380 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11381 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011382 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011383 tcp-request content reject
11384
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011385 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011386 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011387 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011388 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011389 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
11390 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011391
11392 Example:
11393 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11394 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011395 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011396
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011397 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011398 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011399
11400 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011401 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011402 # protecting all our sites
11403 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011404 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11405 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011406 ...
11407 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
11408
11409 backend http_dynamic
11410 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011411 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011412 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011413 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011414 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011415 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011416 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011417
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011418 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011419
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030011420 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
11421 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011422
11423
11424tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
11425 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
11426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011427 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011428 Arguments :
11429 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11430 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11431 as explained at the top of this document.
11432
11433 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
11434 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
11435 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
11436 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
11437 data for at most the specified amount of time.
11438
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011439 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
11440 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
11441 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
11442 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
11443
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011444 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
11445 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011446 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011447 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010011448 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
11449 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
11450 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
11451 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011452
11453 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
11454 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
11455 it pass through unaffected.
11456
11457 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
11458 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
11459 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011460 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011461 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
11462 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020011463 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
11464 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
11465 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011466
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011467 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011468 "timeout client".
11469
11470
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011471tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11472 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
11473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11474 no | no | yes | yes
11475 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011476 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11477 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011478
11479 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11480
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011481 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011482 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11483 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011484 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
11485 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011486
11487 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
11488
11489 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11490 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11491 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11492 inserted.
11493
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011494 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011495 - accept :
11496 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11497 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11498 the rules evaluation.
11499
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011500 - close :
11501 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
11502 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
11503 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
11504 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
11505 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
11506 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011507 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011508 protocols.
11509
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011510 - reject :
11511 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11512 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011513 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011514
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011515 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
11516 Sets a variable.
11517
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011518 - unset-var(<var-name>)
11519 Unsets a variable.
11520
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011521 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11522 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11523 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11524 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11525
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011526 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11527 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11528 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11529 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11530
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011531 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
11532 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11533 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11534 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11535 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011536
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011537 - "silent-drop" :
11538 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011539 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011540 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11541 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11542 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11543 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11544 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011545 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11546 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011547 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11548 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011549 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011550 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11551 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11552 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11553 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11554
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011555 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
11556 Send a group of SPOE messages.
11557
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011558 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11559 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11560 for changing the default action to a reject.
11561
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011562 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
11563 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
11564 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
11565 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011566 period.
11567
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011568 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
11569 declared inline.
11570
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011571 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11572 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011573 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011574 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11575 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011576 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011577 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011578 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011579 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11580 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011581 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011582 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11583 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011584
11585 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11586 followed by some converters.
11587
11588 Example:
11589
11590 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
11591
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011592 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11593 <var-name>.
11594
11595 Example:
11596
11597 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
11598
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011599 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11600 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11601 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11602 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11603 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11604
11605 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11606
11607 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11608
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011609 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11610
11611 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
11612
11613
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011614tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11615 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
11616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11617 no | yes | yes | no
11618 Arguments :
11619 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11620 below.
11621
11622 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11623
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011624 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011625 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
11626 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
11627 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
11628 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
11629 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
11630 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
11631 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011632 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011633 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
11634 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
11635 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
11636 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
11637 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
11638 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
11639 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
11640 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
11641 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
11642 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
11643 instead.
11644
11645 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11646 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11647 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
11648 rules which may be inserted.
11649
11650 Several types of actions are supported :
11651 - accept : the request is accepted
11652 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11653 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
11654 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011655 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011656 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011657 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011658 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011659 - silent-drop
11660
11661 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
11662 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
11663 sections for a complete description.
11664
11665 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11666 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11667 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
11668
11669 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
11670 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
11671 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
11672 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
11673 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
11674
11675 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11676 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11677
11678 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11679 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
11680 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
11681
11682 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11683 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
11684 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11685
11686 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
11687 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11688 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
11689
11690 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11691 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11692 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
11693
11694 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11695
11696 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
11697
11698
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011699tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
11700 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
11701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11702 no | no | yes | yes
11703 Arguments :
11704 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11705 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11706 as explained at the top of this document.
11707
11708 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
11709
11710
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011711timeout check <timeout>
11712 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
11713 established.
11714
11715 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11716 yes | no | yes | yes
11717 Arguments:
11718 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11719 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11720 as explained at the top of this document.
11721
11722 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
11723 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011724 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011725 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010011726 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
11727 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
11728 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011729
11730 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
11731 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
11732
11733 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
11734 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011735 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011736
11737 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11738 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11739 forget about it.
11740
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011741 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
11742 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011743
11744
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011745timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011746 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
11747 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11748 yes | yes | yes | no
11749 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011750 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011751 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11752 as explained at the top of this document.
11753
11754 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11755 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11756 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010011757 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
11758 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
11759 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
11760 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011761 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
11762 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
11763 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011764 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011765 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011766 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
11767 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011768 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
11769 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011770
11771 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11772 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11773 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11774 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011775 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011776 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11777
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011778 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011779
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011780 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011781
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011782
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011783timeout client-fin <timeout>
11784 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
11785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11786 yes | yes | yes | no
11787 Arguments :
11788 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11789 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11790 as explained at the top of this document.
11791
11792 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11793 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11794 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11795 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11796 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
11797 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11798 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010011799 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
11800 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
11801 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011802
11803 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11804 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11805 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
11806
11807 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
11808
11809
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011810timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011811 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
11812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11813 yes | no | yes | yes
11814 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011815 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011816 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11817 as explained at the top of this document.
11818
11819 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011820 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011821 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011822 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011823 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
11824 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011825
11826 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11827 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11828 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11829 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011830 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011831 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11832
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011833 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011834
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011835
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011836timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
11837 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
11838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11839 yes | yes | yes | yes
11840 Arguments :
11841 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11842 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11843 as explained at the top of this document.
11844
11845 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
11846 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
11847 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
11848 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
11849 once the request has started to present itself.
11850
11851 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
11852 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
11853 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
11854 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
11855 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
11856
11857 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
11858 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
11859 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
11860 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
11861
11862 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
11863 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011864 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011865 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
11866 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011867 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011868
11869 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
11870 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
11871 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
11872 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
11873
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011874 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
11875 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011876 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
11877
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011878 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
11879
11880
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011881timeout http-request <timeout>
11882 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
11883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011884 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011885 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011886 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011887 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11888 as explained at the top of this document.
11889
11890 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
11891 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
11892 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
11893 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
11894 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
11895 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
11896 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020011897 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
11898 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
11899 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
11900 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011901 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011902 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
11903 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011904
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011905 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
11906 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
11907 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
11908 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
11909 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011910 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011911
11912 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
11913 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011914 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011915 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
11916 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
11917
11918 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011919 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
11920 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
11921 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011922
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011923 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011924 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011925
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011926
11927timeout queue <timeout>
11928 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
11929 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11930 yes | no | yes | yes
11931 Arguments :
11932 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11933 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11934 as explained at the top of this document.
11935
11936 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
11937 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
11938 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
11939 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
11940 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
11941
11942 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
11943 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
11944 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
11945 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
11946
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011947 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011948
11949
11950timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011951 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
11952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11953 yes | no | yes | yes
11954 Arguments :
11955 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11956 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11957 as explained at the top of this document.
11958
11959 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11960 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11961 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
11962 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
11963 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
11964 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
11965 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
11966
11967 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11968 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11969 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
11970 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
11971 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011972 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011973 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011974 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
11975 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011976 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
11977 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011978
11979 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11980 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11981 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11982 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011983 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011984 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11985
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011986 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011987
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011988
11989timeout server-fin <timeout>
11990 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
11991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11992 yes | no | yes | yes
11993 Arguments :
11994 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11995 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11996 as explained at the top of this document.
11997
11998 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11999 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12000 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12001 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12002 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12003 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12004 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12005 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12006 situations, it should not be needed.
12007
12008 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12009 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12010 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12011
12012 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12013
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012014
12015timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012016 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12018 yes | yes | yes | yes
12019 Arguments :
12020 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12021 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12022 as explained at the top of this document.
12023
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012024 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12025 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12026 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012027
12028 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12029 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12030 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12031 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012032 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012033
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012034 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012035
12036
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012037timeout tunnel <timeout>
12038 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12040 yes | no | yes | yes
12041 Arguments :
12042 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12043 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12044 as explained at the top of this document.
12045
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012046 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012047 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12048 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12049 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012050 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12051 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012052 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12053 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12054 specified.
12055
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012056 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12057 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12058 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12059 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12060 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12061 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12062 state.
12063
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012064 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12065 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12066 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12067 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012068 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012069
12070 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12071 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12072 forget about it.
12073
12074 Example :
12075 defaults http
12076 option http-server-close
12077 timeout connect 5s
12078 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012079 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012080 timeout server 30s
12081 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
12082
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012083 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012084
12085
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012086transparent (deprecated)
12087 Enable client-side transparent proxying
12088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010012089 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012090 Arguments : none
12091
12092 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
12093 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
12094 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
12095 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
12096 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
12097 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
12098 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
12099 appropriate server.
12100
12101 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
12102
12103 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
12104 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
12105
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012106 See also: "option transparent"
12107
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012108unique-id-format <string>
12109 Generate a unique ID for each request.
12110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12111 yes | yes | yes | no
12112 Arguments :
12113 <string> is a log-format string.
12114
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012115 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
12116 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
12117 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
12118 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012119
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012120 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
12121 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
12122 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
12123 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
12124 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
12125 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
12126 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
12127 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012128
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012129 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
12130 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012131
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012132 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012133
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012134 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012135
12136 will generate:
12137
12138 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12139
12140 See also: "unique-id-header"
12141
12142unique-id-header <name>
12143 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
12144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12145 yes | yes | yes | no
12146 Arguments :
12147 <name> is the name of the header.
12148
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012149 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
12150 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012151
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012152 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012153
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012154 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012155 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
12156
12157 will generate:
12158
12159 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12160
12161 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012162
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012163use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012164 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12166 no | yes | yes | no
12167 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012168 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
12169 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012170
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012171 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
12172 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012173
12174 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
12175 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
12176 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012177 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012178 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012179 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
12180 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012181
12182 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
12183 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
12184 assign the backend.
12185
12186 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
12187 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12188 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
12189 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
12190 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
12191 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
12192
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012193 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012194 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012195 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
12196 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
12197 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
12198
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012199 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
12200 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
12201 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
12202 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
12203 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
12204 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
12205 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
12206 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
12207 cannot be forced from the request.
12208
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012209 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012210 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
12211 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
12212
12213 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
12214 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012215
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012216use-fcgi-app <name>
12217 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
12218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12219 no | no | yes | yes
12220 Arguments :
12221 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
12222
12223 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012224
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012225use-server <server> if <condition>
12226use-server <server> unless <condition>
12227 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
12228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12229 no | no | yes | yes
12230 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012231 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
12232 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012233
12234 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
12235
12236 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
12237 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
12238 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
12239
12240 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
12241 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
12242 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
12243 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
12244 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
12245 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
12246 matches will assign the server.
12247
12248 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
12249 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
12250 with the next rules until one matches.
12251
12252 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
12253 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12254 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
12255 according to other persistence mechanisms.
12256
12257 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
12258 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
12259 stripped.
12260
12261 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
12262 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012263 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
12264 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
12265 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012266
12267 Example :
12268 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
12269 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
12270 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
12271 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012272 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012273 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000012274 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012275 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
12276 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
12277
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012278 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
12279 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
12280 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
12281 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050012282 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012283 and we fall back to load balancing.
12284
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012285 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012286
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012287
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100122885. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012289--------------------------
12290
12291The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
12292depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
12293settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
12294written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
12295described in this section.
12296
12297
122985.1. Bind options
12299-----------------
12300
12301The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
12302as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
12303no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
12304parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
12305while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
12306provided immediately after the setting name.
12307
12308The currently supported settings are the following ones.
12309
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012310accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
12311 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
12312 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
12313 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
12314 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
12315 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
12316 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
12317 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
12318 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
12319 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012320 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
12321 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
12322 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012323
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012324accept-proxy
12325 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020012326 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
12327 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012328 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
12329 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
12330 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
12331 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012332 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012333 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
12334 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012335 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
12336 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012337
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012338allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010012339 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012340 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012341 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012342 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
12343 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012344
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012345alpn <protocols>
12346 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12347 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12348 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012349 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012350 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012351 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
12352 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12353 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
12354 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
12355 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
12356 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
12357 preference, like below :
12358
12359 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012360
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012361backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010012362 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012363 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
12364
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010012365curves <curves>
12366 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12367 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
12368 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
12369 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
12370 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
12371 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
12372
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012373ecdhe <named curve>
12374 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010012375 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
12376 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012377
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012378ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012379 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12380 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12381 client's certificate.
12382
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012383ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
12384 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12385 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
12386 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
12387 error is ignored.
12388
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012389ca-sign-file <cafile>
12390 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12391 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
12392 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
12393 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12394 'generate-certificates' for details.
12395
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000012396ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012397 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
12398 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
12399 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12400 'generate-certificates' for details.
12401
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012402ca-verify-file <cafile>
12403 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
12404 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
12405 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
12406 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
12407 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
12408
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012409ciphers <ciphers>
12410 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12411 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000012412 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012413 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012414 information and recommendations see e.g.
12415 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12416 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12417 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
12418
12419ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12420 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12421 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
12422 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
12423 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012424 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
12425 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012426
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012427crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012428 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12429 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12430 to verify client's certificate.
12431
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012432crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012433 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12434 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
12435 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
12436 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
12437 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010012438 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
12439 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012440
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010012441 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
12442 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
12443
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012444 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
12445 are loaded.
12446
12447 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010012448 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
12449 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
12450 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
12451 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
12452 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
12453 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
12454 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012455 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012456
12457 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
12458 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
12459 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
12460 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010012461 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
12462 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012463
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020012464 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012465
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012466 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012467 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012468 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
12469 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012470 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
12471 clients).
12472
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020012473 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
12474 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
12475 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
12476 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
12477 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
12478 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
12479 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
12480 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
12481 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
12482 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
12483 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
12484 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
12485 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
12486
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012487 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
12488 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
12489 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
12490 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
12491 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
12492
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012493 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
12494 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
12495 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
12496 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012497
12498 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
12499 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
12500 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
12501 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
12502 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
12503 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
12504 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
12505 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
12506 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
12507
12508 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
12509
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012510 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012511 a cert bundle.
12512
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012513 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012514 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
12515 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
12516 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
12517 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
12518 provide multi-cert support.
12519
12520 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
12521
12522 Filename | CN | SAN
12523 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
12524 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012525 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012526 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
12527 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
12528
12529 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
12530 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
12531 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
12532 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020012533 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
12534 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
12535 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012536
12537 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
12538 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
12539
12540 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
12541 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
12542 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
12543
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012544crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012545 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012546 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012547 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012548 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012549
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012550crt-list <file>
12551 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012552 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
12553 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012554
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012555 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
12556
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020012557 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
12558 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
12559 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
12560 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
12561 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012562
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012563 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
12564 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
12565 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
12566 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
12567 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
12568 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
12569 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
12570 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012571
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012572 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020012573 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020012574 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
12575 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
12576 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012577
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012578 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
12579
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012580 crt-list file example:
12581 cert1.pem
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012582 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012583 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012584 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012585 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012586
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012587defer-accept
12588 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12589 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
12590 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012591 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012592 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
12593 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
12594 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
12595 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
12596 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
12597 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
12598 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
12599
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012600expose-fd listeners
12601 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
12602 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020012603 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
12604 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012605 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012606
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012607force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012608 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012609 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012610 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012611 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012612
12613force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012614 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012615 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012616 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012617
12618force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012619 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012620 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012621 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012622
12623force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012624 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012625 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012626 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012627
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012628force-tlsv13
12629 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
12630 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012631 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012632
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012633generate-certificates
12634 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12635 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
12636 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
12637 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
12638 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
12639 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
12640 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
12641 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
12642 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
12643 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
12644 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
12645
12646 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
12647 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012648 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012649 certificate is used many times.
12650
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012651gid <gid>
12652 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
12653 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12654 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
12655 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
12656 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12657
12658group <group>
12659 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
12660 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
12661 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
12662 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
12663 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12664
12665id <id>
12666 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
12667 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
12668 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
12669 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
12670
12671interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010012672 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
12673 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
12674 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
12675 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
12676 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
12677 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010012678 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
12679 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
12680 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
12681 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
12682 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
12683 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012684
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012685level <level>
12686 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
12687 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
12688 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012689 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012690 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
12691 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
12692 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012693 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012694 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012695 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012696 all counters).
12697
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020012698severity-output <format>
12699 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
12700 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
12701 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
12702 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
12703 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
12704 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
12705 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
12706 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
12707 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
12708 rfc5424 convention.
12709
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012710maxconn <maxconn>
12711 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
12712 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
12713 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
12714 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
12715 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
12716 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
12717 eat all memory.
12718
12719mode <mode>
12720 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
12721 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
12722 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
12723 UNIX sockets.
12724
12725mss <maxseg>
12726 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
12727 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
12728 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
12729 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
12730 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
12731 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
12732 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
12733 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
12734 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
12735 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
12736 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
12737
12738name <name>
12739 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
12740 page.
12741
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012742namespace <name>
12743 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12744 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
12745 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12746 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12747
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012748nice <nice>
12749 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
12750 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
12751 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
12752 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
12753 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
12754 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
12755 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
12756 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
12757 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
12758 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
12759 one for an RDP socket.
12760
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012761no-ca-names
12762 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12763 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012764 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012765
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012766no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012767 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012768 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012769 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012770 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012771 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
12772 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012773
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012774no-tls-tickets
12775 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12776 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12777 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012778 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
12779 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012780 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12781 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12782 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012783
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012784no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012785 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012786 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012787 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012788 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012789 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12790 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012791
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012792no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012793 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012794 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012795 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012796 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012797 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12798 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012799
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012800no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012801 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012802 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012803 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012804 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012805 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12806 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012807
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012808no-tlsv13
12809 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12810 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
12811 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
12812 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012813 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12814 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012815
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012816npn <protocols>
12817 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12818 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12819 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012820 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012821 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012822 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12823 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
12824 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
12825 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
12826 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012827
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012828prefer-client-ciphers
12829 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
12830 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
12831 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020012832 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
12833 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
12834 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012835
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012836process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012837 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012838 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012839 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012840 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
12841 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
12842 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
12843 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012844 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012845 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
12846 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
12847 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
12848 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
12849 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012850
12851 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
12852
12853 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
12854 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
12855 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
12856 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
12857 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
12858 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
12859 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
12860 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020012861
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012862proto <name>
12863 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
12864 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
12865 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
12866 in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040012867 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012868 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080012869 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012870 h2" on the bind line.
12871
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012872ssl
12873 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012874 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012875 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
12876 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020012877 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
12878 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012879
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012880ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12881 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012882 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
12883 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
12884 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012885 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12886
12887ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012888 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
12889 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
12890 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
12891 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012892
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010012893strict-sni
12894 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
12895 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
12896 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
12897 See the "crt" option for more information.
12898
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012899tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012900 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012901 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
12902 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012903 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012904 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
12905 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
12906 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
12907 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
12908 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
12909 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
12910 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12911
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012912tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010012913 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012914 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
12915 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
12916 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
12917 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
12918 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
12919 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
12920 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020012921 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
12922 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
12923 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012924
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012925tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
12926 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010012927 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
12928 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
12929 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
12930 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
12931 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
12932 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
12933 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
12934 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
12935 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
12936 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012937 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
12938 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
12939
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012940transparent
12941 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12942 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
12943 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
12944 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
12945 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
12946 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
12947 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
12948 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
12949 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
12950 so check for support with your vendor.
12951
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012952v4v6
12953 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12954 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
12955 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
12956 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012957 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012958
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012959v6only
12960 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12961 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
12962 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012963 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
12964 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012965
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012966uid <uid>
12967 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
12968 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12969 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
12970 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
12971 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12972
12973user <user>
12974 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
12975 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12976 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
12977 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
12978 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12979
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012980verify [none|optional|required]
12981 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
12982 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
12983 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
12984 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
12985 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012986 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
12987 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
12988 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
12989 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012990
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200129915.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012992------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012993
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012994The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
12995which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
12996arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
12997settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
12998after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
12999Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13000address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013001
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013002 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013003 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013004
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013005Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13006keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13007
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013008The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013009
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013010addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013011 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013012 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13013 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13014 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13015 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13016 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013017
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013018agent-check
13019 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013020 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013021 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13022 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13023 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013024
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013025 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013026 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013027 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13028 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13029 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013030
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013031 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13032 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13033 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13034 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13035 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013036
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013037 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013038 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013039
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013040 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13041 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13042 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013043
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013044 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13045 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13046 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013047
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013048 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
13049 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13050 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13051 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13052 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013053 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013054 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013055
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013056 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13057 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013058
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013059 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13060 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13061 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13062 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13063 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13064 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13065 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13066 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13067 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013068
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013069 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13070 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013071 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13072 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13073 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013074 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013075
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013076 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013077 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013078
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013079agent-send <string>
13080 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13081 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13082 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13083 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13084 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13085
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013086agent-inter <delay>
13087 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
13088 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13089
13090 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
13091 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
13092 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
13093 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
13094 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13095 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13096 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13097 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13098 of backends use the same servers.
13099
13100 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
13101
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010013102agent-addr <addr>
13103 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
13104
13105 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
13106 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
13107 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
13108 hostname, it will be resolved.
13109
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013110agent-port <port>
13111 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
13112
13113 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
13114
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013115allow-0rtt
13116 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020013117 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
13118 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013119
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013120alpn <protocols>
13121 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13122 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13123 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013124 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013125 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
13126 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
13127 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13128 now obsolete NPN extension.
13129 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
13130 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
13131
13132 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
13133
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013134backup
13135 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
13136 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
13137 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
13138 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013139 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
13140 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013141
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013142ca-file <cafile>
13143 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13144 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13145 server's certificate.
13146
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013147check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013148 This option enables health checks on a server:
13149 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
13150 considered available.
13151 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
13152 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
13153 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
13154 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
13155 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
13156 set.
13157 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
13158 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
13159 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
13160 exchanges succeed.
13161
13162 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
13163 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
13164 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
13165 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
13166 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050013167 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013168 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
13169
13170 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
13171 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
13172
13173 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
13174 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
13175
13176 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
13177 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
13178 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
13179 available.
13180
13181 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
13182 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
13183 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
13184
13185 Example:
13186 # simple tcp check
13187 backend foo
13188 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
13189 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
13190 backend foo
13191 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
13192 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
13193 backend foo
13194 option tcp-check
13195 tcp-check connect
13196 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013197
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020013198check-send-proxy
13199 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
13200 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
13201 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
13202 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
13203 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
13204 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
13205 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
13206
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010013207check-alpn <protocols>
13208 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
13209 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
13210 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
13211
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013212check-proto <name>
13213 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
13214 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
13215 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
13216 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013217 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013218 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
13219 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
13220
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013221check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013222 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013223 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
13224 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013225
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013226check-ssl
13227 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
13228 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
13229 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
13230 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013231 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013232 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
13233 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013234 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013235 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
13236 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013237
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013238check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013239 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013240 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
13241 for normal traffic.
13242
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013243ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013244 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
13245 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
13246 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013247 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
13248 information and recommendations see e.g.
13249 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13250 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13251 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013252
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013253ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13254 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13255 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
13256 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
13257 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013258 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
13259 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
13260 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013261
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013262cookie <value>
13263 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
13264 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
13265 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
13266 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
13267 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
13268 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
13269 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
13270
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013271crl-file <crlfile>
13272 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13273 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13274 to verify server's certificate.
13275
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020013276crt <cert>
13277 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13278 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
13279 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
13280 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
13281 certificate request.
13282
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013283disabled
13284 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
13285 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
13286 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
13287 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
13288 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013289 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013290
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013291enabled
13292 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
13293 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
13294 default value.
13295 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
13296 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013297
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013298error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010013299 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
13300 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
13301 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013302
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013303 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013304
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013305fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013306 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
13307 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
13308 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
13309
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013310force-sslv3
13311 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13312 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013313 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013314 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013315
13316force-tlsv10
13317 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013318 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013319 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013320
13321force-tlsv11
13322 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013323 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013324 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013325
13326force-tlsv12
13327 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013328 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013329 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013330
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013331force-tlsv13
13332 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13333 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013334 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013335
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013336id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020013337 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
13338 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
13339 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013340
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013341init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
13342 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
13343 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013344 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013345 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
13346 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
13347 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
13348 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
13349 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
13350 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
13351 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
13352 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
13353 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013354 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013355 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
13356 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
13357 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
13358 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
13359 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
13360 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013361 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013362
13363 Example:
13364 defaults
13365 # never fail on address resolution
13366 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
13367
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013368inter <delay>
13369fastinter <delay>
13370downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013371 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
13372 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13373 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
13374 between checks depending on the server state :
13375
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020013376 Server state | Interval used
13377 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13378 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
13379 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13380 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
13381 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
13382 or yet unchecked. |
13383 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13384 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
13385 | "inter" otherwise.
13386 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013387
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013388 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
13389 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
13390 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
13391 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013392 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13393 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13394 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13395 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13396 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013397
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020013398log-proto <logproto>
13399 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
13400 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
13401 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
13402 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
13403
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013404maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013405 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
13406 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013407 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
13408 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013409 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
13410 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
13411 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
13412 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
13413
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013414 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
13415 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
13416 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
13417 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
13418 than 50 concurrent requests.
13419
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013420maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013421 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
13422 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
13423 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
13424 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
13425 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
13426 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
13427 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
13428
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010013429max-reuse <count>
13430 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
13431 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
13432 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
13433 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
13434 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
13435 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
13436 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
13437 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
13438
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013439minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013440 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
13441 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
13442 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
13443 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
13444 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
13445 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013446 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013447 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013448
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013449namespace <name>
13450 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13451 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
13452 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13453 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13454
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013455no-agent-check
13456 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
13457 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13458 default value.
13459 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13460 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
13461
13462no-backup
13463 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
13464 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13465 default value.
13466 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13467 "default-server" "backup" setting.
13468
13469no-check
13470 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
13471 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13472 default value.
13473 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13474 "default-server" "check" setting.
13475
13476no-check-ssl
13477 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
13478 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13479 default value.
13480 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13481 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
13482
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013483no-send-proxy
13484 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
13485 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13486 default value.
13487 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13488 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
13489
13490no-send-proxy-v2
13491 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
13492 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13493 default value.
13494 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13495 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
13496
13497no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
13498 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
13499 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13500 default value.
13501 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13502 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
13503
13504no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13505 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
13506 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13507 default value.
13508 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13509 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
13510
13511no-ssl
13512 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
13513 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13514 default value.
13515 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13516 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
13517
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010013518no-ssl-reuse
13519 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
13520 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
13521 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
13522 and for paranoid users.
13523
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013524no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013525 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13526 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013527 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013528
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013529 Supported in default-server: No
13530
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013531no-tls-tickets
13532 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13533 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13534 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013535 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
13536 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013537 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13538 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13539 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013540 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013541
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013542no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013543 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013544 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13545 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013546 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13547 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013548 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013549
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013550 Supported in default-server: No
13551
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013552no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013553 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013554 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13555 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013556 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13557 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013558 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013559
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013560 Supported in default-server: No
13561
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013562no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013563 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013564 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13565 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013566 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13567 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013568 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013569
13570 Supported in default-server: No
13571
13572no-tlsv13
13573 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13574 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13575 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
13576 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13577 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013578 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013579
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013580 Supported in default-server: No
13581
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013582no-verifyhost
13583 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
13584 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13585 default value.
13586 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13587 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013588
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013589no-tfo
13590 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
13591 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13592 default value.
13593 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13594 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
13595
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090013596non-stick
13597 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
13598 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
13599 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
13600
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013601npn <protocols>
13602 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13603 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13604 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013605 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013606 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
13607 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13608 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
13609
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013610observe <mode>
13611 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
13612 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
13613 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
13614 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
13615 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
13616 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010013617 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013618
13619 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
13620
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013621on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013622 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
13623 Currently, four modes are available:
13624 - fastinter: force fastinter
13625 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
13626 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
13627 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
13628 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
13629
13630 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
13631
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013632on-marked-down <action>
13633 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
13634 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013635 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
13636 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
13637 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
13638 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
13639 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
13640 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
13641 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
13642 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013643
13644 Actions are disabled by default
13645
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013646on-marked-up <action>
13647 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
13648 Currently one action is available:
13649 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
13650 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
13651 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
13652 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013653 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
13654 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013655 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
13656 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
13657
13658 Actions are disabled by default
13659
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020013660pool-low-conn <max>
13661 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
13662 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
13663 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
13664 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
13665 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
13666 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
13667 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
13668 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
13669 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
13670 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
13671 applying to "http-reuse".
13672
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010013673pool-max-conn <max>
13674 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
13675 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
13676 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
13677 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
13678 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
13679 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
13680
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013681pool-purge-delay <delay>
13682 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010013683 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020013684 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013685
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013686port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013687 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
13688 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
13689 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
13690 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
13691 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
13692 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
13693
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013694proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013695 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
13696 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
13697 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
13698 reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013699 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013700 protocol for all connections established to this server.
13701
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013702redir <prefix>
13703 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
13704 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
13705 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
13706 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
13707 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
13708 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
13709 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
13710 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013711 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013712 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013713 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
13714 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
13715 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
13716 loop between the client and HAProxy!
13717
13718 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
13719
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013720rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013721 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
13722 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
13723 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
13724
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013725resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
13726 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
13727 server.
13728
13729 Available options:
13730
13731 * allow-dup-ip
13732 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
13733 resolution at runtime is in operation.
13734 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
13735 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
13736 For such case, simply enable this option.
13737 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
13738
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050013739 * ignore-weight
13740 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
13741 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
13742 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
13743
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013744 * prevent-dup-ip
13745 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
13746 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
13747 same fqdn.
13748 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
13749
13750 Example:
13751 backend b_myapp
13752 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
13753 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13754 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13755
13756 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
13757 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
13758 it
13759 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
13760 different address
13761
13762 Default value: not set
13763
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013764resolve-prefer <family>
13765 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
13766 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
13767 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
13768 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
13769
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020013770 Default value: ipv6
13771
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013772 Example:
13773
13774 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013775
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013776resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013777 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013778 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013779 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013780 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
13781 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013782 configured network, another address is selected.
13783
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013784 Example:
13785
13786 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013787
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013788resolvers <id>
13789 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
13790 hostname.
13791
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013792 Example:
13793
13794 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013795
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013796 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013797
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013798send-proxy
13799 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
13800 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
13801 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
13802 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013803 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
13804 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
13805 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
13806 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
13807 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
13808 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
13809 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
13810 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
13811 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
13812 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013813 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
13814 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013815
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013816send-proxy-v2
13817 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
13818 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13819 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13820 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020013821 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
13822 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
13823 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
13824 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013825
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013826proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010013827 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
13828 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
13829
13830 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
13831 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
13832 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
13833 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
13834 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
13835 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
13836 connection is supported).
13837 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
13838 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
13839 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
13840 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
13841 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
13842 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
13843 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013844
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013845send-proxy-v2-ssl
13846 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13847 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13848 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13849 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13850 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13851 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
13852 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013853 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
13854 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013855
13856send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13857 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13858 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13859 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13860 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13861 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13862 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
13863 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
13864 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013865 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
13866 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013867
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013868slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013869 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
13870 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
13871 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
13872 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
13873 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
13874 parameters :
13875
13876 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
13877 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
13878
13879 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
13880 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
13881 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
13882 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
13883
13884 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
13885 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
13886 seen as failed.
13887
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013888sni <expression>
13889 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
13890 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
13891 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
13892 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020013893 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
13894 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013895 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010013896 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
13897 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013898
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013899source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020013900source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013901source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013902 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
13903 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
13904 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
13905 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
13906
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013907 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
13908 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
13909 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
13910 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
13911 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
13912 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
13913 server.
13914
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000013915 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
13916 specifying the source address without port(s).
13917
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013918ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020013919 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
13920 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
13921 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
13922 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
13923 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
13924 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013925 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
13926 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013927
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013928ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13929 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
13930 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13931 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13932
13933ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13934 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
13935 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13936 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
13937
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013938ssl-reuse
13939 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
13940 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13941 default value.
13942 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13943 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
13944
13945stick
13946 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
13947 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13948 default value.
13949 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13950 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013951
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013952socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013953 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013954 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
13955 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
13956
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013957tcp-ut <delay>
13958 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
13959 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
13960 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013961 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013962 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
13963 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
13964 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
13965 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
13966 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
13967 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
13968 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
13969 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
13970 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13971
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013972tfo
13973 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
13974 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
13975 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
13976 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
13977 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013978 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013979
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013980track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020013981 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
13982 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
13983 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
13984 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013985 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
13986
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013987tls-tickets
13988 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
13989 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13990 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013991 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13992 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13993 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013994 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010013995 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013996
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013997verify [none|required]
13998 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010013999 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014000 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14001 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014002 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014003 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14004 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14005 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14006 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14007 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14008 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14009 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14010 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014011
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014012verifyhost <hostname>
14013 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014014 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14015 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14016 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14017 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14018 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14019 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14020 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14021 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014022
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014023weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014024 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14025 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14026 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014027 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14028 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14029 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14030 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14031 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14032 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014033
14034
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200140355.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14036-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014037
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014038HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14039using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
14040configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014041This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14042can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14043workload.
14044This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14045resolution at run time.
14046Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
14047carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
14048
14049
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200140505.3.1. Global overview
14051----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014052
14053As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
14054different steps of the process life:
14055
14056 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
14057 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
14058 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
14059
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014060 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
14061 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014062
14063A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
14064 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
14065 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
14066 resolution to know this new IP.
14067
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014068When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014069HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014070SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
14071from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
14072will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
14073will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020014074
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014075A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014076 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014077 first valid response.
14078
14079 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
14080 servers return an error.
14081
14082
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200140835.3.2. The resolvers section
14084----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014085
14086This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014087HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
14088contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014089
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014090When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
14091uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
14092is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
14093answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
14094
14095When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014096used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014097
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014098 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
14099 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
14100 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014101
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014102 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
14103 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014104
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014105 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
14106 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
14107 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014108
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014109For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
14110following scenarios are possible:
14111
14112 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
14113 ignored
14114
14115 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
14116 applied
14117
14118 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
14119 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
14120
14121 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
14122 retries the query with a new type
14123
14124 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
14125 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014126
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014127As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
14128a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014129<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014130
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014131
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014132resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014133 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014134
14135A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
14136
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014137accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014138 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014139 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014140 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
14141 by RFC 6891)
14142
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020014143 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
14144
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014145nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
14146 DNS server description:
14147 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
14148 <ip> : IP address of the server
14149 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
14150
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014151parse-resolv-conf
14152 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
14153 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
14154 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
14155
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014156hold <status> <period>
14157 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
14158 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014159 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014160 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014161 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
14162 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14163 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
14164
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020014165 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014166
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014167resolve_retries <nb>
14168 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
14169 giving up.
14170 Default value: 3
14171
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014172 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
14173 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
14174 type.
14175
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014176timeout <event> <time>
14177 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
14178 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
14179 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014180 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
14181 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014182 Default value: 1s
14183 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014184 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014185 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014186 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14187 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
14188
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014189 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014190
14191 resolvers mydns
14192 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
14193 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014194 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014195 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014196 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014197 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014198 hold other 30s
14199 hold refused 30s
14200 hold nx 30s
14201 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014202 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014203 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014204
14205
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200142066. Cache
14207---------
14208
14209HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
14210(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
14211RAM.
14212
14213The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
14214this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
14215
14216If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
14217independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
14218when we try to allocate a new one.
14219
14220The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
14221
14222It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
14223"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
14224for more details.
14225
14226When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
14227replaced by "<CACHE>".
14228
14229
142306.1. Limitation
14231----------------
14232
14233The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
14234
14235- If the response is not a 200
14236- If the response contains a Vary header
14237- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
14238- If the response is not cacheable
14239
14240- If the request is not a GET
14241- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
14242- If the request contains an Authorization header
14243
14244
142456.2. Setup
14246-----------
14247
14248To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
14249the corresponding http-request and response actions.
14250
14251
142526.2.1. Cache section
14253---------------------
14254
14255cache <name>
14256 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
14257 size of cache is mandatory.
14258
14259total-max-size <megabytes>
14260 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
14261 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
14262
14263max-object-size <bytes>
14264 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
14265 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
14266 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
14267
14268max-age <seconds>
14269 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
14270 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
14271 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
14272 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
14273 default.
14274
14275
142766.2.2. Proxy section
14277---------------------
14278
14279http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14280 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
14281 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
14282 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
14283 after this one.
14284
14285http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14286 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
14287 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
14288 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
14289 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
14290
14291
14292Example:
14293
14294 backend bck1
14295 mode http
14296
14297 http-request cache-use foobar
14298 http-response cache-store foobar
14299 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
14300
14301 cache foobar
14302 total-max-size 4
14303 max-age 240
14304
14305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200143067. Using ACLs and fetching samples
14307----------------------------------
14308
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014309HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014310client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
14311The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
14312these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
14313but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
14314data called patterns.
14315
14316
143177.1. ACL basics
14318---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014319
14320The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
14321content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
14322from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
14323simple :
14324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014325 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014326 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014327 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
14328 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014330The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
14331adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014332
14333In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
14334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014335 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014336
14337This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
14338Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
14339and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014340an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
14341conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
14342as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
14343are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014344
14345ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
14346'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
14347which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
14348
14349There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
14350performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
14351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014352The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
14353specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
14354this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014355methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
14356ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014357
14358Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
14359 - boolean
14360 - integer (signed or unsigned)
14361 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
14362 - string
14363 - data block
14364
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014365Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
14366converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
14367would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
14368The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
14369which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
14370
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014371Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
14372keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
14373fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
14374which are summarized in the table below :
14375
14376 +---------------------+-----------------+
14377 | Sample or converter | Default |
14378 | output type | matching method |
14379 +---------------------+-----------------+
14380 | boolean | bool |
14381 +---------------------+-----------------+
14382 | integer | int |
14383 +---------------------+-----------------+
14384 | ip | ip |
14385 +---------------------+-----------------+
14386 | string | str |
14387 +---------------------+-----------------+
14388 | binary | none, use "-m" |
14389 +---------------------+-----------------+
14390
14391Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
14392matching method, see below.
14393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014394The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
14395 - boolean
14396 - integer or integer range
14397 - IP address / network
14398 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
14399 - regular expression
14400 - hex block
14401
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014402The following ACL flags are currently supported :
14403
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014404 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
14405 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014406 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014407 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014408 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014409 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014410 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
14411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014412The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
14413read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
14414if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
14415lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
14416will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
14417beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
14418a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
14419lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
14420exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
14421
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014422The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
14423parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
14424ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
14425a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
14426check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
14427
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014428The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
14429socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
14430file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
14431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014432Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
14433loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
14434
14435 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
14436
14437In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
14438the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
14439case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
14440as well.
14441
14442The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
14443sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
14444do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
14445methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
14446is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014447obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014448followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
14449default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
14450that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
14451string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
14452
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014453The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
14454By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
14455string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
14456resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
14457server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014458waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014459flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
14460function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
14461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014462There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
14463sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
14464be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014465
14466 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
14467 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014468 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
14469 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
14470 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
14471 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014472
14473 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
14474 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014475 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014476
14477 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014478 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014479
14480 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014481 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014482
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014483 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014484 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
14485
14486 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
14487 binary or string samples.
14488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014489 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
14490 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014492 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
14493 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
14494 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014496 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
14497 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014499 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
14500 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014502 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
14503 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014505 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
14506 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014507 This may be used with binary or string samples.
14508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014509 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
14510 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
14511 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014512
14513For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
14514request, it is possible to do :
14515
14516 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
14517
14518In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
14519buffer, one would use the following acl :
14520
14521 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
14522
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014523On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
14524possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
14525
14526 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
14527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014528All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
14529criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
14530method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
14531to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
14532criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
14533the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014535If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014536the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
14537For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014539 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
14540 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
14541 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
14542 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014543
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014544
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014545The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
14546types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
14547combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
14548brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
14549default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014551 +-------------------------------------------------+
14552 | Input sample type |
14553 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014554 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014555 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14556 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
14557 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014558 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014559 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014560 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014561 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014562 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014563 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014564 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014565 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014566 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014567 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014568 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014569 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014570 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014571 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014572 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014573 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014574 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014575 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014576 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014577 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014578 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014579 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14580 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
14581 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014582
14583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200145847.1.1. Matching booleans
14585------------------------
14586
14587In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
14588Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
14589When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
14590that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
14591
14592Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
14593return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
14594"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
14595
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200145977.1.2. Matching integers
14598------------------------
14599
14600Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
14601enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
14602to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
14603
14604Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
14605matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
14606lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014607
14608For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
14609unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
14610representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
14611
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014612As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
14613two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
14614instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
14615ranges and operators.
14616
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014617For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014618operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
14619Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
14620of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014621
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014622Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014623
14624 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
14625 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
14626 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
14627 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
14628 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
14629
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014630For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014631
14632 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
14633
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014634This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
14635
14636 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
14637
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146397.1.3. Matching strings
14640-----------------------
14641
14642String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
14643different forms :
14644
14645 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014646 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014647
14648 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014649 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014650
14651 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
14652 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14653
14654 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
14655 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14656
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010014657 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014658 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
14659 matches.
14660
14661 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
14662 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
14663 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014664
14665String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
14666exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
14667characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
14668string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
14669to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014670before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014671
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010014672Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
14673(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
14674Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
14675
14676Example:
14677 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
14678 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
14679
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
14682---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014683
14684Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
14685they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
14686possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
14687passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
14688the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014689the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
14690match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014691
14692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146937.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
14694-------------------------------------
14695
14696It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
14697not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
14698a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
14699to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
14700digits may be used upper or lower case.
14701
14702Example :
14703 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
14704 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
14705
14706
147077.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
14708---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014709
14710IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
14711netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
14712within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014713host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014714difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
14715at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
14716does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
14717parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014718
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020014719The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
14720abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
14721
14722 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14723 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
14724 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14725 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
14726 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
14727 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
14728 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
14729 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14730
14731Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
14732192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
14733
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014734IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
14735Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
14736trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
14737IPv6 patterns.
14738
14739HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
14740following situations :
14741 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
14742 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
14743 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
14744 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
14745 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
14746 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
14747 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
14748 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
14749 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
14750 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
14751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014752
147537.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
14754----------------------------------
14755
14756Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
14757combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
14758
14759 - AND (implicit)
14760 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
14761 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014763A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014765 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014767Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
14768indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014770For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
14771"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
14772requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
14773is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
14774
14775 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014776 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
14777 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
14778 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014779
14780To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
14781and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
14782
14783 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
14784 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
14785 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
14786 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
14787
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014788 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014789 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
14790 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
14791 use_backend www if host_www
14792
14793It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
14794expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
14795be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
14796the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
14797
14798 The following rule :
14799
14800 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014801 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014802
14803 Can also be written that way :
14804
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014805 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014806
14807It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
14808to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
14809simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
14810sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
14811good use is the following :
14812
14813 With named ACLs :
14814
14815 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
14816 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
14817 monitor fail if site_dead
14818
14819 With anonymous ACLs :
14820
14821 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
14822
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014823See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
14824keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014825
14826
148277.3. Fetching samples
14828---------------------
14829
14830Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
14831against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
14832sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
14833ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
14834of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
14835available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
14836
14837This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
14838Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
14839compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
14840deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
14841
14842The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
14843matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
14844method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
14845indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
14846
14847As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
14848when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
14849mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
14850the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
14851ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
14852
14853Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
14854multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
14855when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014856incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
14857are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014858is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
14859all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
14860
14861Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
14862 - name
14863 - name(arg1)
14864 - name(arg1,arg2)
14865
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014866
148677.3.1. Converters
14868-----------------
14869
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014870Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
14871of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
14872is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
14873was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014874has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014875unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
14876
14877These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
14878sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
14879the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014880support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014881
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014882A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
14883support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
14884supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
14885(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
14886bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
14887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014888The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014889
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001489051d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
14891 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14892 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14893 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
14894 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14895 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14896
14897 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014898 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
14899 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000014900 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
14901 frontend http-in
14902 bind *:8081
14903 default_backend servers
14904 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14905 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14906
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014907add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014908 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014909 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014910 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
14911 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014912 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014913 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14914 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14915 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14916 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014917 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014918 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014919
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010014920aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
14921 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
14922 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
14923 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
14924 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
14925 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
14926 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
14927
14928 Example:
14929 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
14930 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
14931
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014932and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014933 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014934 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014935 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14936 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014937 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014938 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14939 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14940 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14941 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014942 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014943 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014944
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020014945b64dec
14946 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
14947 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
14948
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014949base64
14950 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014951 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014952 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
14953
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014954bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014955 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014956 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014957 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014958 presence of a flag).
14959
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014960bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
14961 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
14962 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014963 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014964
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014965concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
14966 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
14967 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
14968 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
14969 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
14970 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
14971 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
14972 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
14973 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
14974 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
14975 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014976 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014977 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014978 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
14979 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014980
14981 Example:
14982 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
14983 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
14984 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014985 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014986 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
14987
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014988cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014989 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
14990 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014991
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014992crc32([<avalanche>])
14993 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
14994 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14995 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14996 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14997 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14998 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
14999 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
15000 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15001 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15002 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015003 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15004
15005crc32c([<avalanche>])
15006 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15007 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15008 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15009 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
15010 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
15011 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
15012 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
15013 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015014
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020015015cut_crlf
15016 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
15017 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
15018 updated.
15019
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010015020da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015021 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
15022 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
15023 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
15024 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015025 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015026 configuration language.
15027
15028 Example:
15029 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015030 bind *:8881
15031 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015032 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015033
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010015034debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
15035 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
15036 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
15037 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
15038 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
15039 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
15040 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
15041 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
15042 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
15043 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
15044 printable sample types.
15045
15046 Example:
15047 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020015048
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015049digest(<algorithm>)
15050 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
15051 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
15052
15053 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15054 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15055
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015056div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015057 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15058 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015059 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015060 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
15061 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015062 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015063 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15064 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15065 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15066 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015067 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015068 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015069
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015070djb2([<avalanche>])
15071 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
15072 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15073 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15074 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15075 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15076 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15077 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015078 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
15079 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015080
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015081even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015082 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015083 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
15084
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015085field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15086 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
15087 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
15088 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
15089 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
15090 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
15091 fields.
15092
15093 Example :
15094 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
15095 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15096 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
15097 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
15098 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010015099
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015100hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015101 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015102 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015103 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015104 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010015105
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015106hex2i
15107 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015108 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015109
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020015110htonl
15111 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
15112 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
15113 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
15114 unsigned 32-bit integer.
15115
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015116hmac(<algorithm>, <key>)
15117 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
15118 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
15119 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
15120 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
15121
15122 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15123 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15124
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015125http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015126 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15127 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015128 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
15129 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
15130 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
15131 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
15132 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
15133 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
15134 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
15135 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015136
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015137in_table(<table>)
15138 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15139 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
15140 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015141 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015142 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
15143
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015144ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
15145 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015146 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015147 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
15148 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
15149 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
15150 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
15151 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015152
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015153json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015154 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015155 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015156 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015157 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
15158 of errors:
15159 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
15160 bytes, ...)
15161 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
15162 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
15163
15164 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
15165 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
15166 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
15167 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
15168 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
15169 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015170 - "ascii" : never fails;
15171 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
15172 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015173 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015174 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015175 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
15176 characters corresponding to the other errors.
15177
15178 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015179 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015180
15181 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015182 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015183 capture request header user-agent len 150
15184 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015185
15186 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
15187 GET / HTTP/1.0
15188 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
15189
15190 Output log:
15191 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
15192
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015193language(<value>[,<default>])
15194 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
15195 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
15196 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
15197 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
15198 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
15199 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
15200 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
15201 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
15202 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015203 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015204 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
15205 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015206
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015207 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015208
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015209 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
15210 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015211
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015212 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
15213 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
15214 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
15215 use_backend spanish if es
15216 use_backend french if fr
15217 use_backend english if en
15218 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015219
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010015220length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010015221 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
15222 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15223 type. The result is of type integer.
15224
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015225lower
15226 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
15227 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15228 type. The result is of type string.
15229
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015230ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
15231 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15232 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
15233 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15234 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15235 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15236 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
15237
15238 Example :
15239
15240 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015241 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015242 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15243
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020015244ltrim(<chars>)
15245 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
15246 representation of the input sample.
15247
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015248map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15249map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15250map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15251 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
15252 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
15253 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
15254 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
15255 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
15256 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
15257 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
15258 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015259
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015260 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
15261 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
15262 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015263
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015264 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015265 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015266
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015267 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
15268 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15269 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
15270 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020015271 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
15272 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015273 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
15274 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15275 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
15276 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15277 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
15278 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15279 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
15280 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080015281 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
15282 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15283 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015284 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15285 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
15286 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15287 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
15288 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015289
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010015290 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
15291 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
15292 the corresponding match text.
15293
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015294 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
15295 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
15296 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
15297 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
15298 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015299
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015300 Example :
15301
15302 # this is a comment and is ignored
15303 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
15304 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
15305 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
15306 | | | `---------- value
15307 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
15308 | `---------------------------- key
15309 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
15310
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015311mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015312 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15313 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015314 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015315 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015316 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015317 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15318 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15319 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15320 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015321 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015322 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015323
15324mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015325 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020015326 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
15327 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015328 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015329 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015330 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015331 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15332 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15333 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15334 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015335 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015336 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015337
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010015338nbsrv
15339 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
15340 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
15341 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
15342 map lookup.
15343
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015344neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015345 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
15346 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
15347 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
15348 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015349
15350not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015351 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015352 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015353 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015354 absence of a flag).
15355
15356odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015357 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015358 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
15359
15360or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015361 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015362 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015363 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15364 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015365 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015366 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15367 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15368 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15369 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015370 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015371 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015372
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015373protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
15374 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
15375 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
15376 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
15377 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
15378 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15379 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15380 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15381 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
15382 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
15383 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15384 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
15385
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010015386regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015387 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
15388 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
15389 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
15390 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
15391 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
15392 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
15393 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
15394 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
15395 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015396 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
15397 of characters with other ones.
15398
15399 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
15400 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
15401 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
15402 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
15403 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
15404 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015405
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015406 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015407
15408 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
15409 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
15410 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015411 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015412
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015413 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
15414 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
15415
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015416 # capture groups and backreferences
15417 # both lines do the same.
15418 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)]'
15419 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
15420
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015421capture-req(<id>)
15422 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
15423 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15424
15425 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015426 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15427 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015428
15429capture-res(<id>)
15430 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
15431 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15432
15433 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015434 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15435 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015436
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020015437rtrim(<chars>)
15438 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
15439 of the input sample.
15440
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015441sdbm([<avalanche>])
15442 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
15443 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15444 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15445 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15446 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15447 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15448 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015449 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
15450 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015451
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015452secure_memcmp(<var>)
15453 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
15454 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
15455 match.
15456
15457 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
15458 performed in constant time.
15459
15460 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15461 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15462
15463 Example :
15464
15465 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
15466 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
15467 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
15468 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
15469
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015470set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015471 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
15472 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
15473 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015474 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015475 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15476 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015477 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015478 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15479 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015480 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015481 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015482
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015483sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015484 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015485 sample with length of 20 bytes.
15486
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015487sha2([<bits>])
15488 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
15489 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
15490
15491 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
15492 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
15493
15494 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15495 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15496
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020015497srv_queue
15498 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
15499 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
15500 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
15501 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
15502 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
15503
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015504strcmp(<var>)
15505 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
15506 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
15507 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
15508 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
15509 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
15510 shorter).
15511
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015512 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
15513 strings in constant time.
15514
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015515 Example :
15516
15517 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
15518 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
15519 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
15520
15521
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015522sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015523 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
15524 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015525 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015526 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
15527 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015528 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015529 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15530 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015531 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015532 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15533 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015534 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015535 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015536
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015537table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
15538 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15539 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15540 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
15541 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15542 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15543 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
15544
15545
15546table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
15547 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15548 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15549 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
15550 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15551 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15552 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
15553
15554table_conn_cnt(<table>)
15555 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15556 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015557 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015558 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
15559 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15560
15561table_conn_cur(<table>)
15562 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15563 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15564 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15565 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15566 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
15567
15568table_conn_rate(<table>)
15569 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15570 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15571 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
15572 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15573 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
15574
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015575table_gpt0(<table>)
15576 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15577 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
15578 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15579 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15580 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
15581
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015582table_gpc0(<table>)
15583 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15584 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15585 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15586 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15587 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
15588
15589table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
15590 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15591 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15592 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
15593 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15594 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
15595 sample fetch keyword.
15596
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015597table_gpc1(<table>)
15598 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15599 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15600 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
15601 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15602 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
15603
15604table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
15605 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15606 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15607 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
15608 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15609 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
15610 sample fetch keyword.
15611
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015612table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
15613 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15614 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015615 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015616 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15617 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15618
15619table_http_err_rate(<table>)
15620 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15621 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15622 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
15623 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
15624 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
15625 keyword.
15626
15627table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
15628 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15629 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015630 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015631 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
15632 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15633
15634table_http_req_rate(<table>)
15635 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15636 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15637 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
15638 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
15639 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
15640 keyword.
15641
15642table_kbytes_in(<table>)
15643 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15644 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015645 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015646 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15647 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15648 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
15649 keyword.
15650
15651table_kbytes_out(<table>)
15652 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15653 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015654 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015655 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15656 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15657 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
15658 keyword.
15659
15660table_server_id(<table>)
15661 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15662 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15663 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
15664 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
15665 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
15666 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
15667
15668table_sess_cnt(<table>)
15669 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15670 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015671 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015672 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
15673 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15674 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
15675 keyword.
15676
15677table_sess_rate(<table>)
15678 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15679 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15680 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
15681 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
15682 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15683 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
15684 keyword.
15685
15686table_trackers(<table>)
15687 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15688 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15689 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15690 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
15691 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
15692 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
15693 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
15694 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
15695 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
15696 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
15697
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015698upper
15699 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
15700 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15701 type. The result is of type string.
15702
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020015703url_dec([<in_form>])
15704 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
15705 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
15706 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
15707 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
15708 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
15709 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020015710
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015711ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015712 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015713 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
15714 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
15715 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015716 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15717 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15718 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15719 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015720 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015721 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15722 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015723
15724 Example:
15725 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
15726 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
15727
15728 message Point {
15729 int32 latitude = 1;
15730 int32 longitude = 2;
15731 }
15732
15733 message PPoint {
15734 Point point = 59;
15735 }
15736
15737 message Rectangle {
15738 // One corner of the rectangle.
15739 PPoint lo = 48;
15740 // The other corner of the rectangle.
15741 PPoint hi = 49;
15742 }
15743
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015744 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
15745 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
15746 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015747
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015748 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15749 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015750 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015751 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
15752
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015753 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015754
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015755 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015756
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015757 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
15758 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15759 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015760
15761 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
15762 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
15763 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
15764
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015765 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
15766 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
15767 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015768
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015769
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010015770unset-var(<var name>)
15771 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
15772 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
15773 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
15774 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15775 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
15776 response),
15777 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15778 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
15779 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
15780 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
15781
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015782utime(<format>[,<offset>])
15783 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15784 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
15785 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15786 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15787 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15788 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
15789
15790 Example :
15791
15792 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015793 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015794 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15795
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015796word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15797 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
15798 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
15799 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015800 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015801 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
15802 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
15803
15804 Example :
15805 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
15806 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15807 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
15808 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
15809 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015810 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010015811
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015812wt6([<avalanche>])
15813 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
15814 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15815 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15816 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15817 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15818 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15819 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015820 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
15821 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015822
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015823xor(<value>)
15824 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015825 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015826 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015827 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015828 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015829 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15830 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015831 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015832 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15833 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015834 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015835 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015836
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010015837xxh32([<seed>])
15838 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
15839 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15840 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15841 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15842 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15843 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15844 as cryptographically secure.
15845
15846xxh64([<seed>])
15847 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
15848 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15849 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15850 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15851 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15852 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15853 as cryptographically secure.
15854
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015855
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200158567.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015857--------------------------------------------
15858
15859A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
15860not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
15861"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
15862The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
15863
15864always_false : boolean
15865 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15866 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15867
15868always_true : boolean
15869 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15870 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15871
15872avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015873 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015874 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
15875 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
15876 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
15877 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
15878 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
15879 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
15880 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
15881 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
15882 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
15883 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
15884 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
15885 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
15886 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010015887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015888be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015889 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
15890 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
15891 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
15892 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015893 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
15894
15895be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
15896 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15897 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
15898 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
15899 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
15900 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015901 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
15902 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015903
15904 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
15905 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
15906 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015908be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
15909 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15910 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15911 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015912 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015913 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
15914 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015915
15916 Example :
15917 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
15918 backend dynamic
15919 mode http
15920 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
15921 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015922
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015923bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015924 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
15925 of the string.
15926
15927bool(<bool>) : bool
15928 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
15929 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
15930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015931connslots([<backend>]) : integer
15932 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015933 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015934 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
15935 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050015936
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015937 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015938 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015939 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
15940
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015941 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
15942 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015943
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015944 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015945 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015946 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015947 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015948 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015949 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015950 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015951
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015952 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
15953 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015954 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015955 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015956
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015957cpu_calls : integer
15958 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
15959 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
15960 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
15961 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
15962 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
15963 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
15964
15965cpu_ns_avg : integer
15966 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15967 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15968 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15969 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15970 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15971 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15972 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
15973 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
15974 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
15975 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
15976 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15977
15978cpu_ns_tot : integer
15979 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15980 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15981 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15982 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15983 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15984 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15985 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
15986 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
15987 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
15988 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
15989 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
15990 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
15991 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
15992
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015993date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015994 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015995
15996 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
15997 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
15998 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015999 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
16000
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016001 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
16002 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
16003 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
16004 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
16005 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
16006
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016007 Example :
16008
16009 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
16010 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016011
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016012 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
16013 # millisecond granularity
16014 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
16015
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010016016date_us : integer
16017 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
16018 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
16019 from the same timeval structure.
16020
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020016021distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
16022 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
16023 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
16024 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
16025 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
16026 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
16027 list of supported tokens.
16028
16029distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
16030 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
16031 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
16032 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
16033 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
16034 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
16035 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
16036 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
16037 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
16038 supported tokens.
16039
16040 Example :
16041 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
16042 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
16043 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
16044 # send large files to the big farm
16045 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
16046
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020016047env(<name>) : string
16048 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
16049 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
16050 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
16051 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
16052 certain way.
16053
16054 Examples :
16055 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
16056 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
16057
16058 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
16059 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
16060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016061fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
16062 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016063 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
16064 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016065 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
16066 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016067 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016068 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
16069 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016070
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020016071fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16072 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
16073 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
16074 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
16075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016076fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16077 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16078 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16079 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
16080 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
16081 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
16082 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
16083 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
16084 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016085
16086 Example :
16087 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
16088 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
16089 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
16090 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
16091 frontend mail
16092 bind :25
16093 mode tcp
16094 maxconn 100
16095 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
16096 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
16097 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
16098 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016099
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010016100hostname : string
16101 Returns the system hostname.
16102
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016103int(<integer>) : signed integer
16104 Returns a signed integer.
16105
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016106ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
16107 Returns an ipv4.
16108
16109ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
16110 Returns an ipv6.
16111
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016112lat_ns_avg : integer
16113 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16114 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16115 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16116 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16117 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16118 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16119 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16120 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16121 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016122 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16123 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16124 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16125 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16126 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
16127 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016128
16129lat_ns_tot : integer
16130 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16131 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16132 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16133 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16134 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16135 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16136 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16137 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16138 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016139 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16140 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16141 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16142 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16143 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016144 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
16145 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
16146 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
16147 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
16148 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
16149 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
16150
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016151meth(<method>) : method
16152 Returns a method.
16153
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016154nbproc : integer
16155 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
16156 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
16157 and debugging purposes.
16158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016159nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
16160 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
16161 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
16162 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016163 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
16164 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
16165 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016166
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040016167prio_class : integer
16168 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
16169 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
16170 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
16171
16172prio_offset : integer
16173 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
16174 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
16175 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
16176 set-priority-offset".
16177
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016178proc : integer
16179 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
16180 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
16181 debugging purposes.
16182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016183queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016184 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
16185 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
16186 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016187 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
16188 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
16189 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
16190 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
16191 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
16192
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010016193rand([<range>]) : integer
16194 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
16195 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
16196 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
16197 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
16198 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
16199
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020016200uuid([<version>]) : string
16201 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
16202 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
16203 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
16204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016205srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16206 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16207 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
16208 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
16209 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
16210 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016211 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
16212 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
16213
16214srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16215 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16216 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
16217 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16218 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
16219 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
16220 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
16221 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
16222
16223 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
16224 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016225
16226srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
16227 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
16228 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
16229 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016230 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016231 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
16232 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
16233 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
16234
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020016235srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16236 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
16237 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16238 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
16239 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
16240 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
16241 fetch methods.
16242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016243srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16244 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16245 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016246 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016247 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
16248 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016249 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016250 overloading servers).
16251
16252 Example :
16253 # Redirect to a separate back
16254 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
16255 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
16256 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
16257
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020016258srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16259 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
16260 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
16261 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
16262
16263srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16264 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
16265 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16266 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
16267
16268srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16269 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
16270 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16271 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
16272
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016273stopping : boolean
16274 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
16275 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
16276 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
16277
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016278str(<string>) : string
16279 Returns a string.
16280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016281table_avl([<table>]) : integer
16282 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
16283 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
16284
16285table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16286 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
16287 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
16288 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
16289
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010016290thread : integer
16291 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
16292 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
16293 and debugging purposes.
16294
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016295var(<var-name>) : undefined
16296 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016297 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
16298 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016299 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016300 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16301 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016302 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016303 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16304 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016305 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016306 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016307
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200163087.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016309----------------------------------
16310
16311The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
16312closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
16313methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
16314sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
16315TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016316the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
16317counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020016318"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
16319used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
16320can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
16321Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
16322table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
16323tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
16324currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016325
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010016326bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010016327 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16328 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16329 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
16330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016331be_id : integer
16332 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016333 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16334 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016335
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016336be_name : string
16337 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016338 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16339 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016341dst : ip
16342 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
16343 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
16344 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
16345 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016346 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
16347 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
16348 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
16349 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
16350 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
16351 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016352
16353dst_conn : integer
16354 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16355 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
16356 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
16357 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
16358 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
16359 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
16360 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
16361 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016362
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016363dst_is_local : boolean
16364 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
16365 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
16366 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
16367 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016368 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016369 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
16370 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
16371 it only once per connection.
16372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016373dst_port : integer
16374 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
16375 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
16376 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
16377 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
16378 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
16379 an HTTP header.
16380
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020016381fc_http_major : integer
16382 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16383 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16384 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
16385
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020016386fc_pp_authority : string
16387 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16388 if any.
16389
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010016390fc_pp_unique_id : string
16391 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16392 if any.
16393
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010016394fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
16395 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
16396 header.
16397
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020016398fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
16399 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
16400 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
16401 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
16402 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16403 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16404 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16405
16406fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
16407 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
16408 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
16409 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
16410 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16411 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16412 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16413
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016414fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016415 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16416 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16417 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16418 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16419
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016420fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016421 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16422 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16423 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16424 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16425
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016426fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016427 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
16428 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16429 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16430 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16431
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016432fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016433 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
16434 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16435 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16436 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16437
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016438fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016439 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
16440 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16441 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16442 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16443
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016444fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016445 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
16446 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16447 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16448 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16449
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020016450fe_defbe : string
16451 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
16452 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
16453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016454fe_id : integer
16455 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010016456 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016457 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16458
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016459fe_name : string
16460 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
16461 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
16462 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16463
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016464sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016465sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16466sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16467sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016468 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
16469 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16470 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
16471
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016472sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016473sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16474sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16475sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016476 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
16477 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16478 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
16479
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016480sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016481sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16482sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16483sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016484 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16485 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016486 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16487 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16488 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016489
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016490 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016491 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16492 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016493 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16494 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
16495 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016496 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16497 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16498
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016499sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16500sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16501sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16502sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16503 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16504 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
16505 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16506 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16507 when a first ACL was verified.
16508
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016509sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016510sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16511sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16512sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016513 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016514 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
16515
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016516sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016517sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16518sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16519sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016520 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16521 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
16522 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
16523
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016524sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016525sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16526sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16527sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016528 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
16529 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
16530 See also src_conn_rate.
16531
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016532sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016533sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16534sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16535sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016536 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016537 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016538
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016539sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16540sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16541sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16542sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16543 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16544 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16545
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016546sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16547sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16548sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16549sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16550 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16551 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
16552
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016553sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016554sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16555sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16556sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016557 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
16558 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16559 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016560 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16561 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16562 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016563
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016564sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16565sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16566sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16567sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16568 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16569 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16570 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16571 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16572 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16573 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16574
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016575sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016576sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16577sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16578sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016579 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016580 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
16581 See also src_http_err_cnt.
16582
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016583sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016584sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16585sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16586sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016587 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
16588 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16589 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
16590 src_http_err_rate.
16591
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016592sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016593sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16594sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16595sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016596 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016597 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16598 src_http_req_cnt.
16599
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016600sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016601sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16602sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16603sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016604 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
16605 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
16606 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16607 src_http_req_rate.
16608
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016609sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016610sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16611sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16612sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016613 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016614 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16615 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16616 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16617 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016618
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016619 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016620 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16621 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016622 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16623
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016624sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16625sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16626sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16627sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16628 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
16629 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16630 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16631 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16632 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
16633
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016634sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016635sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16636sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16637sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016638 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
16639 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16640 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016641
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016642sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016643sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16644sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16645sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016646 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
16647 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16648 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016649
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016650sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016651sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16652sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16653sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016654 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016655 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
16656 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
16657 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016658 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016659 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
16660
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016661sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016662sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16663sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16664sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016665 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
16666 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16667 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
16668 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
16669 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016670 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016671
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016672sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016673sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16674sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16675sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020016676 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
16677 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
16678 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
16679
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016680sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016681sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16682sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16683sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016684 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16685 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016686 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016687 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
16688 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016689 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
16690 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
16691 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016693so_id : integer
16694 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
16695 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
16696 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016697
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010016698so_name : string
16699 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
16700 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
16701 strings instead of integers.
16702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016703src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016704 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016705 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
16706 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
16707 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016708 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
16709 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
16710 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016711 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
16712 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
16713 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
16714 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
16715 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
16716 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
16717 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016718
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016719 Example:
16720 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
16721 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
16722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016723src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16724 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
16725 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
16726 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016727 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016729src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16730 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
16731 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016732 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016733 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016735src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16736 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16737 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16738 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16739 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16740 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16741 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016742
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016743 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016744 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16745 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
16746 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
16747 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016748 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016749 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16750 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16751
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016752src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16753 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16754 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16755 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16756 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16757 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16758 was verified.
16759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016760src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016761 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016762 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016763 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016764 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016766src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016767 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016768 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16769 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016770 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016772src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16773 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
16774 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16775 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016776 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016778src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016779 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016780 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016781 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016782 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016783
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016784src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16785 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16786 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16787 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16788 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
16789
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016790src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16791 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16792 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16793 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16794 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
16795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016796src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016797 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016798 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016799 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16800 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016801 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16802 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16803 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016804
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016805src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16806 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16807 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16808 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16809 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16810 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16811 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16812 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016814src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016815 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016816 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016817 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016818 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016819 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016821src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16822 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
16823 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16824 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16825 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016826 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016828src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016829 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016830 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16831 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016832 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016834src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16835 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
16836 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16837 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016838 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016839 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016841src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16842 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16843 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16844 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016845 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016846 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16847 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016848
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016849 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016850 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016851 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016852 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016853
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016854src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16855 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16856 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16857 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
16858 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16859 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16860 connection when a first ACL was verified.
16861
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016862src_is_local : boolean
16863 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
16864 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
16865 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
16866 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016867 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016868 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
16869 once per connection.
16870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016871src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016872 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
16873 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
16874 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
16875 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
16876 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016877
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016878src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016879 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
16880 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16881 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
16882 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
16883 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016885src_port : integer
16886 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
16887 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
16888 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
16889 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016891src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016892 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016893 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16894 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
16895 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016896 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016898src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16899 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
16900 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16901 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16902 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016903 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016905src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16906 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
16907 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
16908 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
16909 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
16910 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
16911 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
16912 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
16913 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016914
16915 Example :
16916 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
16917 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
16918 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
16919 listen ssh
16920 bind :22
16921 mode tcp
16922 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016923 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016924 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016925 server local 127.0.0.1:22
16926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016927srv_id : integer
16928 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
16929 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016930 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020016931
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016932srv_name : string
16933 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
16934 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016935 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016936
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200169377.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016938----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020016939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016940The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
16941closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
16942when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
16943usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016944future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016945
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001694651d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
16947 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16948 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16949 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
16950 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16951 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16952
16953 Example :
16954 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
16955 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
16956 # the request.
16957 frontend http-in
16958 bind *:8081
16959 default_backend servers
16960 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16961 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16962
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016963ssl_bc : boolean
16964 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16965 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016966 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16967 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016968
16969ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
16970 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016971 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
16972 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016973
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016974ssl_bc_alpn : string
16975 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
16976 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016977 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016978 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16979 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16980 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
16981 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
16982 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016983 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
16984 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016985
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016986ssl_bc_cipher : string
16987 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016988 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16989 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016990
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016991ssl_bc_client_random : binary
16992 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16993 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16994 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016995 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016996
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010016997ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
16998 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16999 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017000 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17001 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017002
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017003ssl_bc_npn : string
17004 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
17005 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017006 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017007 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
17008 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
17009 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
17010 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017011 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
17012 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017013
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017014ssl_bc_protocol : string
17015 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017016 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17017 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017018
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017019ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017020 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017021 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017022 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
17023 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017024
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017025ssl_bc_server_random : binary
17026 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17027 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17028 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017029 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017030
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017031ssl_bc_session_id : binary
17032 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
17033 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017034 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17035 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017036
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017037ssl_bc_session_key : binary
17038 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
17039 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17040 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017041 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017042
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017043ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
17044 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017045 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17046 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017048ssl_c_ca_err : integer
17049 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17050 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
17051 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
17052 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
17053 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017054
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017055ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
17056 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17057 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
17058 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
17059 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017060
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010017061ssl_c_der : binary
17062 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
17063 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17064 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17065
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017066ssl_c_der_chain : binary
17067 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
17068 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17069 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17070 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17071 does not support resumed sessions.
17072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017073ssl_c_err : integer
17074 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17075 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
17076 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
17077 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
17078 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017079
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017080ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017081 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17082 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17083 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17084 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17085 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17086 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17087 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17088 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017089 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17090 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17091 LDAP v3.
17092 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17093 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017095ssl_c_key_alg : string
17096 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17097 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17098 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017100ssl_c_notafter : string
17101 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
17102 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17103 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017105ssl_c_notbefore : string
17106 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
17107 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17108 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017109
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017110ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017111 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17112 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17113 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17114 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17115 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17116 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17117 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17118 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017119 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17120 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17121 LDAP v3.
17122 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17123 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017125ssl_c_serial : binary
17126 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
17127 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17128 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017130ssl_c_sha1 : binary
17131 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
17132 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
17133 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017134 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
17135 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
17136
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017137 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017138 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017139
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017140ssl_c_sig_alg : string
17141 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17142 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17143 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017145ssl_c_used : boolean
17146 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
17147 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017149ssl_c_verify : integer
17150 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
17151 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
17152 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
17153 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017155ssl_c_version : integer
17156 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
17157 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017158
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010017159ssl_f_der : binary
17160 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
17161 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17162 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17163
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017164ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017165 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17166 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17167 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17168 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017169 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017170 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17171 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17172 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017173 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17174 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17175 LDAP v3.
17176 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17177 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017179ssl_f_key_alg : string
17180 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17181 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
17182 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017184ssl_f_notafter : string
17185 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17186 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17187 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017189ssl_f_notbefore : string
17190 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17191 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17192 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017193
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017194ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017195 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17196 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17197 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17198 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17199 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17200 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17201 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17202 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017203 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17204 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17205 LDAP v3.
17206 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17207 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017209ssl_f_serial : binary
17210 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17211 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17212 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017213
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020017214ssl_f_sha1 : binary
17215 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
17216 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17217 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017219ssl_f_sig_alg : string
17220 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17221 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17222 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017224ssl_f_version : integer
17225 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17226 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17227
17228ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017229 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17230 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
17231 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
17232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017233 Example :
17234 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
17235 listen http-https
17236 bind :80
17237 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
17238 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
17239
17240ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
17241 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
17242 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17243
17244ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017245 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017246 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
17247 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
17248 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17249 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17250 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
17251 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
17252 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
17253 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
17254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017255ssl_fc_cipher : string
17256 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
17257 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020017258
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017259ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
17260 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
17261 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017262 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017263
17264ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
17265 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
17266 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017267 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017268
17269ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
17270 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
17271 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
17272 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017273 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020017274 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017275
17276ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
17277 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
17278 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017279 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017280
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017281ssl_fc_client_random : binary
17282 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17283 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17284 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17285
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017286ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
17287 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17288 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17289 transport layer.
17290 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17291 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17292 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17293 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17294
17295ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17296 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17297 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17298 transport layer.
17299 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17300 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17301 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17302 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17303
17304ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
17305 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17306 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17307 transport layer.
17308 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17309 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17310 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17311 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17312
17313ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
17314 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17315 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17316 transport layer.
17317 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17318 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17319 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17320 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17321
17322ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
17323 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17324 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17325 transport layer.
17326 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17327 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17328 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17329 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017331ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017332 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
17333 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010017334 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
17335 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
17336 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
17337 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017338
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020017339ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
17340 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
17341 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
17342 wait until the handshake happened.
17343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017344ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
17345 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017346 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
17347 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017348 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017349 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017350
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020017351ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017352 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010017353 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
17354 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017356ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017357 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017358 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
17359 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
17360 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
17361 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
17362 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
17363 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
17364 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020017365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017366ssl_fc_protocol : string
17367 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
17368 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017369
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017370ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017371 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017372 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
17373 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017374
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017375ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17376 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17377 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17378 transport layer.
17379 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17380 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17381 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17382 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17383
17384ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
17385 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17386 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17387 transport layer.
17388 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17389 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17390 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17391 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17392
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017393ssl_fc_server_random : binary
17394 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17395 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17396 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017398ssl_fc_session_id : binary
17399 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
17400 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
17401 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
17402 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017403
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017404ssl_fc_session_key : binary
17405 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
17406 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17407 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
17408 BoringSSL.
17409
17410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017411ssl_fc_sni : string
17412 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
17413 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
17414 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
17415 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
17416 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
17417
17418 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
17419 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
17420 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017421 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020017422 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017424 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017425 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
17426 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020017427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017428ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
17429 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
17430 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017431
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017432ssl_s_der : binary
17433 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
17434 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17435 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17436
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017437ssl_s_chain_der : binary
17438 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
17439 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17440 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17441 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17442 does not support resumed sessions.
17443
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017444ssl_s_key_alg : string
17445 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17446 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
17447 SSL/TLS transport layer.
17448
17449ssl_s_notafter : string
17450 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
17451 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17452 transport layer.
17453
17454ssl_s_notbefore : string
17455 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
17456 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17457 transport layer.
17458
17459ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17460 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17461 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17462 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17463 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17464 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17465 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017466 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17467 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017468 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17469 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17470 LDAP v3.
17471 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17472 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17473
17474ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17475 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17476 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17477 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17478 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17479 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17480 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017481 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17482 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017483 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17484 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17485 LDAP v3.
17486 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17487 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17488
17489ssl_s_serial : binary
17490 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
17491 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17492 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17493
17494ssl_s_sha1 : binary
17495 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
17496 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17497 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17498
17499ssl_s_sig_alg : string
17500 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17501 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17502 layer.
17503
17504ssl_s_version : integer
17505 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
17506 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017507
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200175087.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017509------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017511Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
17512sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
17513only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
17514For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
17515be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
17516can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
17517sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
17518for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
17519content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017521payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017522 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017523 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
17524 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017526payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
17527 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017528 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017529 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017530
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020017531req.hdrs : string
17532 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
17533 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
17534 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
17535 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
17536
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020017537req.hdrs_bin : binary
17538 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
17539 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
17540 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
17541 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
17542 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
17543 names and values (length of 0 for both).
17544
17545 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
17546
17547 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
17548 str: <int:length><bytes>
17549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017550req.len : integer
17551req_len : integer (deprecated)
17552 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17553 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17554 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17555 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17556 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17557 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17558 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
17559 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017561req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17562 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017563 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
17564 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
17565 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
17566 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017568 ACL alternatives :
17569 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017571req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17572 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17573 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17574 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
17575 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017577 ACL alternatives :
17578 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017580 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017582req.proto_http : boolean
17583req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
17584 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
17585 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
17586 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
17587 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
17588 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
17589 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
17590 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017592 Example:
17593 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
17594 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17595 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017596 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017598req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
17599rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17600 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
17601 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
17602 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
17603 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
17604 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
17605 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
17606 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017608 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
17609 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
17610 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
17611 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
17612 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
17613 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017615 ACL derivatives :
17616 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017618 Example :
17619 listen tse-farm
17620 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
17621 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
17622 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17623 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
17624 # apply RDP cookie persistence
17625 persist rdp-cookie
17626 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
17627 # This is only useful makes sense if
17628 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
17629 stick-table type string size 204800
17630 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
17631 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
17632 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017634 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
17635 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017637req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
17638rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
17639 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
17640 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
17641 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
17642 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017644 ACL derivatives :
17645 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017646
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017647req.ssl_alpn : string
17648 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
17649 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
17650 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
17651 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
17652 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
17653 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017654 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017655
17656 Examples :
17657 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17658 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17659 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017660 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017661 default_backend bk_default
17662
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017663req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
17664 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
17665 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020017666 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
17667 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
17668 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
17669 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
17670 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017672req.ssl_hello_type : integer
17673req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17674 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17675 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
17676 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17677 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17678 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
17679 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17680 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017682req.ssl_sni : string
17683req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
17684 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
17685 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
17686 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
17687 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17688 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020017689 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
17690 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
17691 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
17692 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
17693 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
17694 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
17695 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
17696 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
17697 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017699 ACL derivatives :
17700 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017702 Examples :
17703 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17704 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17705 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
17706 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
17707 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017708
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053017709req.ssl_st_ext : integer
17710 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
17711 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
17712 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
17713 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
17714 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
17715 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
17716 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
17717 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
17718 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
17719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017720req.ssl_ver : integer
17721req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
17722 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
17723 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
17724 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
17725 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
17726 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17727 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
17728 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017729 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017730 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017732 ACL derivatives :
17733 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017734
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017735res.len : integer
17736 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17737 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17738 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17739 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17740 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17741 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17742 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017743 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017745res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17746 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017747 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017748 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017749 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017750 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017752res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17753 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17754 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17755 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017756 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
17757 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017759 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017760
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020017761res.ssl_hello_type : integer
17762rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17763 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17764 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
17765 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17766 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17767 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
17768 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17769 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
17770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017771wait_end : boolean
17772 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
17773 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017774 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017775 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
17776 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017777 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017778 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
17779 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017781 Examples :
17782 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
17783 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
17784 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017786 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
17787 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17788 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
17789 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
17790 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
17791 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
17792 tcp-request content reject
17793
17794
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200177957.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017796--------------------------------------
17797
17798It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
17799This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
17800data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
17801its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
17802HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
17803content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
17804to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
17805more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
17806response are indexed.
17807
17808base : string
17809 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
17810 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
17811 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
17812 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
17813 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
17814 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
17815 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
17816 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
17817
17818 ACL derivatives :
17819 base : exact string match
17820 base_beg : prefix match
17821 base_dir : subdir match
17822 base_dom : domain match
17823 base_end : suffix match
17824 base_len : length match
17825 base_reg : regex match
17826 base_sub : substring match
17827
17828base32 : integer
17829 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
17830 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
17831 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017832 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
17833 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
17834 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017835
17836base32+src : binary
17837 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
17838 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
17839 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
17840 per-URL counters.
17841
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017842capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
17843 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
17844 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17845 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
17846
17847capture.req.method : string
17848 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
17849 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
17850 because it's allocated.
17851
17852capture.req.uri : string
17853 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
17854 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
17855 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
17856 allocated.
17857
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017858capture.req.ver : string
17859 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17860 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
17861 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
17862
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017863capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
17864 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
17865 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17866 The first entry is an index of 0.
17867 See also: "capture response header"
17868
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017869capture.res.ver : string
17870 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17871 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
17872 persistent flag.
17873
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017874req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017875 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
17876 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
17877 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017878
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020017879req.body_param([<name>) : string
17880 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
17881 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
17882 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
17883 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
17884 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
17885 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
17886 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
17887 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
17888 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
17889 given.
17890
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017891req.body_len : integer
17892 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
17893 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017894 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
17895 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017896
17897req.body_size : integer
17898 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017899 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
17900 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017902req.cook([<name>]) : string
17903cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17904 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17905 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
17906 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
17907 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
17908 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
17909 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
17910 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
17911 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
17912
17913 ACL derivatives :
17914 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
17915 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
17916 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
17917 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
17918 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
17919 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
17920 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
17921 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017923req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17924cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17925 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17926 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017928req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17929cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17930 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17931 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
17932 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
17933 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017935cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17936 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17937 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
17938 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
17939 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017940 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017941 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
17942 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
17943 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
17944 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017946hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17947 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
17948 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
17949 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
17950 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017951 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017953req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
17954 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17955 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17956 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17957 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17958 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17959 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
17960 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
17961 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017963req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17964 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17965 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17966 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17967 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017969req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17970 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17971 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17972 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17973 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17974 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17975 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
17976 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
17977 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000017978 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017979 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017980 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017982 ACL derivatives :
17983 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17984 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17985 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17986 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17987 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17988 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17989 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17990 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17991
17992req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17993hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
17994 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17995 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
17996 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
17997 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
17998 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
17999 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
18000 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
18001 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
18002 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
18003
18004req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18005hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18006 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
18007 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
18008 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
18009 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18010 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018011 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018012 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
18013 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
18014
18015req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18016hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18017 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
18018 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
18019 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
18020 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18021 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18022 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18023 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
18024
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018025
18026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018027http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
18028 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
18029 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
18030 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18031 basic auth is supported.
18032
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018033http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
18034 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
18035 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
18036 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
18037 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018038 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18039 basic auth is supported.
18040
18041 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018042 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
18043 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
18044 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
18045 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018046
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018047http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018048 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
18049 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18050 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018051
18052http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018053 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
18054 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18055 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018056
18057http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018058 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
18059 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
18060 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018062http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018063 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
18064 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018065 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
18066 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018067
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018068method : integer + string
18069 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
18070 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
18071 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
18072 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
18073 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
18074 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
18075 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018077 ACL derivatives :
18078 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018080 Example :
18081 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
18082 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
18083 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018085path : string
18086 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
18087 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
18088 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
18089 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
18090 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018091 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018092 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018094 ACL derivatives :
18095 path : exact string match
18096 path_beg : prefix match
18097 path_dir : subdir match
18098 path_dom : domain match
18099 path_end : suffix match
18100 path_len : length match
18101 path_reg : regex match
18102 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018103
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018104query : string
18105 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
18106 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
18107 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
18108 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018109 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018110 which stops before the question mark.
18111
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018112req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18113 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18114 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18115 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
18116 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
18117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018118req.ver : string
18119req_ver : string (deprecated)
18120 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
18121 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
18122 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018124 ACL derivatives :
18125 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018126
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018127res.body : binary
18128 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
18129 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18130 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18131 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18132
18133res.body_len : integer
18134 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
18135 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18136 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18137 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18138
18139res.body_size : integer
18140 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
18141 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18142 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
18143 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
18144 useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It may be used in tcp-check
18145 based expect rules.
18146
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018147res.comp : boolean
18148 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
18149 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
18150 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018152res.comp_algo : string
18153 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
18154 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
18155 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018157res.cook([<name>]) : string
18158scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18159 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18160 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018161 specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may be used in tcp-check
18162 based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018164 ACL derivatives :
18165 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018167res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18168scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18169 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18170 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018171 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses. It may
18172 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018174res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18175scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18176 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18177 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018178 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may
18179 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018181res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18182 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18183 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18184 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18185 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18186 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
18187 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
18188 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
18189 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018190 Expires. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018192res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18193 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18194 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18195 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
18196 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018197 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in
18198 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018200res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18201shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
18202 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18203 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18204 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18205 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18206 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
18207 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
18208 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018209 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in tcp-check based
18210 expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018212 ACL derivatives :
18213 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18214 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18215 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18216 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18217 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18218 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18219 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18220 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18221
18222res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18223shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18224 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18225 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18226 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
18227 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018228 instead. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018230res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18231shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18232 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
18233 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
18234 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
18235 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
18236 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018237 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table. It
18238 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018239
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018240res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18241 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18242 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18243 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018244 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered. It may be used
18245 in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018247res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18248shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18249 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
18250 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18251 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
18252 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
18253 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018254 useful to learn some data into a stick table. It may be used in tcp-check
18255 based expect rules.
18256
18257res.hdrs : string
18258 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
18259 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18260 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
18261 headers analyzers and for advanced logging. It may also be used in tcp-check
18262 based expect rules.
18263
18264res.hdrs_bin : binary
18265 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18266 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
18267 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
18268 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
18269 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
18270 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
18271 (length of 0 for both).
18272
18273 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
18274
18275 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18276 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018278res.ver : string
18279resp_ver : string (deprecated)
18280 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018281 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. It may be used in
18282 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018284 ACL derivatives :
18285 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018287set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18288 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18289 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018290 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018291 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018293 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
18294 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018296status : integer
18297 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
18298 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018299 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx. It may be used in
18300 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018301
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020018302unique-id : string
18303 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
18304 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
18305 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
18306 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
18307 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
18308 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
18309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018310url : string
18311 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
18312 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
18313 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
18314 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
18315 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
18316 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
18317 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018319 ACL derivatives :
18320 url : exact string match
18321 url_beg : prefix match
18322 url_dir : subdir match
18323 url_dom : domain match
18324 url_end : suffix match
18325 url_len : length match
18326 url_reg : regex match
18327 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018329url_ip : ip
18330 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
18331 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
18332 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
18333 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
18334 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
18335 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18336 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018338url_port : integer
18339 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
18340 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
18341 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18342 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018343
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018344urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
18345url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018346 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
18347 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018348 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
18349 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
18350 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
18351 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018352 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
18353 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018354 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
18355 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018357 ACL derivatives :
18358 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
18359 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
18360 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
18361 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
18362 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
18363 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
18364 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
18365 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018366
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018368 Example :
18369 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
18370 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
18371 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
18372 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018373
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018374urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018375 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
18376 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
18377 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020018378
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020018379url32 : integer
18380 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
18381 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
18382 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
18383 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
18384 is an unsigned integer.
18385
18386url32+src : binary
18387 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
18388 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
18389 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
18390
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020018391
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200183927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018393---------------------------------------
18394
18395This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
18396used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
18397purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
18398There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
18399or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
18400any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
18401for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
18402
18403internal.htx.data : integer
18404 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
18405 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18406
18407internal.htx.free : integer
18408 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
18409 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18410
18411internal.htx.free_data : integer
18412 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
18413 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18414
18415internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
18416 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
18417 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
18418 chosen depending on the sample direction.
18419
18420internal.htx.nbblks : integer
18421 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
18422 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18423
18424internal.htx.size : integer
18425 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
18426 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18427
18428internal.htx.used : integer
18429 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
18430 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18431 direction.
18432
18433internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
18434 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18435 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
18436 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
18437 of the special value :
18438 * head : The oldest inserted block
18439 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018440 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018441
18442internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
18443 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18444 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
18445 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
18446 integer or one of the special value :
18447 * head : The oldest inserted block
18448 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018449 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018450
18451internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
18452 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18453 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
18454 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18455 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18456
18457 * head : The oldest inserted block
18458 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018459 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018460
18461internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
18462 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18463 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18464 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18465 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18466
18467 * head : The oldest inserted block
18468 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018469 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018470
18471internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
18472 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18473 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18474 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18475 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18476
18477 * head : The oldest inserted block
18478 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018479 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018480
18481internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
18482 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
18483 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
18484 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18485 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18486
18487 * head : The oldest inserted block
18488 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018489 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018490
18491internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
18492 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
18493 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
18494 it returns false.
18495
18496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200184977.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018498---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018499
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018500Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
18501every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020018502order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018503
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018504ACL name Equivalent to Usage
18505---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018506FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020018507HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018508HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
18509HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018510HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
18511HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
18512HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
18513HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
18514LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018515METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018516METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018517METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
18518METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
18519METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
18520METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018521METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018522METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018523RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018524REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018525TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018526WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
18527---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018528
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010018529
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185308. Logging
18531----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018532
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018533One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
18534provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
18535very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
18536provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
18537state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018538to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018539headers.
18540
18541In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
18542about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
18543send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
18544
18545 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
18546 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
18547 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
18548 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
18549 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018550 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060018551 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018552
18553The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
18554allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
18555as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
18556while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
18557real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
18558delay.
18559
18560
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185618.1. Log levels
18562---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018563
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018564TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018565source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018566HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
18567in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
18568track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
18569syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
18570about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018571
18572
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185738.2. Log formats
18574----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018575
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018576HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018577and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
18578slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
18579options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018580
18581 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
18582 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
18583 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
18584 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
18585 extents.
18586
18587 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
18588 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
18589 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
18590 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
18591 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
18592
18593 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
18594 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
18595 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
18596 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
18597 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
18598
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020018599 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
18600 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
18601 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
18602 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
18603
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018604 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
18605
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018606Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
18607specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
18608field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
18609servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
18610always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
18611identifier.
18612
18613Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
18614 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
18615 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
18616 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
18617 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
18618
18619
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186208.2.1. Default log format
18621-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018622
18623This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
18624as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
18625format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
18626
18627 Example :
18628 listen www
18629 mode http
18630 log global
18631 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18632
18633 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
18634 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
18635 (www/HTTP)
18636
18637 Field Format Extract from the example above
18638 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
18639 2 'Connect from' Connect from
18640 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
18641 4 'to' to
18642 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
18643 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
18644
18645Detailed fields description :
18646 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
18647 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
18648 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
18649 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
18650 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18651 and processed the connection.
18652 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
18653
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018654In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
18655"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
18656connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
18657
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018658It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
18659will eventually disappear.
18660
18661
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186628.2.2. TCP log format
18663---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018664
18665The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
18666is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
18667information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
18668counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
18669emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
18670environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
18671the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
18672sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018673specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
18674not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
18675fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
18676marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018677
18678 Example :
18679 frontend fnt
18680 mode tcp
18681 option tcplog
18682 log global
18683 default_backend bck
18684
18685 backend bck
18686 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18687
18688 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
18689 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
18690 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
18691
18692 Field Format Extract from the example above
18693 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
18694 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
18695 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
18696 4 frontend_name fnt
18697 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
18698 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
18699 7 bytes_read* 212
18700 8 termination_state --
18701 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
18702 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18703
18704Detailed fields description :
18705 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018706 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18707 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18708 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018709 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018710 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018711 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018712
18713 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018714 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18715 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18716 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018717
18718 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
18719 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
18720 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018721 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
18722 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
18723 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
18724 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018725
18726 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18727 and processed the connection.
18728
18729 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18730 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18731 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
18732 applications.
18733
18734 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18735 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18736 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18737 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
18738 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
18739
18740 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18741 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
18742 See "Timers" below for more details.
18743
18744 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18745 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
18746 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
18747 "Timers" below for more details.
18748
18749 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018750 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018751 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
18752 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
18753 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
18754 details.
18755
18756 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
18757 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
18758 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
18759 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
18760 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
18761
18762 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18763 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18764 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
18765 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
18766 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
18767 for more details.
18768
18769 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018770 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018771 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
18772 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
18773 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018774 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018775
18776 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18777 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18778 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18779 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18780 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18781 caused by a denial of service attack.
18782
18783 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18784 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18785 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18786 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18787 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18788 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18789 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18790 denial of service attack.
18791
18792 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18793 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18794 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18795 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18796 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18797 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18798 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18799 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
18800 be processed than on other servers.
18801
18802 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18803 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18804 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18805 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18806 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18807 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18808 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18809 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18810 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18811 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18812 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18813 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18814 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18815
18816 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18817 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18818 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18819 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18820 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18821 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018822 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018823 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18824
18825 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18826 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18827 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18828 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18829 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18830 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018831 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018832 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18833 occurs.
18834
18835
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188368.2.3. HTTP log format
18837----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018838
18839The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
18840is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
18841the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
18842are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
18843emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
18844generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
18845"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
18846which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018847frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
18848is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018849
18850Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
18851slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
18852with a star ('*') after the field name below.
18853
18854 Example :
18855 frontend http-in
18856 mode http
18857 option httplog
18858 log global
18859 default_backend bck
18860
18861 backend static
18862 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18863
18864 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
18865 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
18866 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018867 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018868
18869 Field Format Extract from the example above
18870 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
18871 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018872 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018873 4 frontend_name http-in
18874 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018875 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018876 7 status_code 200
18877 8 bytes_read* 2750
18878 9 captured_request_cookie -
18879 10 captured_response_cookie -
18880 11 termination_state ----
18881 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
18882 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18883 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
18884 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
18885 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018886
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018887Detailed fields description :
18888 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018889 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18890 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18891 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018892 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018893 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018894 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018895
18896 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018897 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18898 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18899 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018900
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018901 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
18902 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018903
18904 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18905 and processed the connection.
18906
18907 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18908 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18909 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
18910
18911 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18912 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18913 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18914 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
18915 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
18916 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
18917
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018918 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
18919 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
18920 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018921 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018922 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
18923 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018924 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
18925 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018926
18927 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18928 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018929 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018930
18931 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18932 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018933 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
18934 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018935
18936 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
18937 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
18938 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
18939 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
18940 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018941 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
18942 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018943
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018944 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
18945 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
18946 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
18947 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
18948 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
18949 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
18950 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018951 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018952
18953 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
18954 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
18955 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
18956
18957 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
18958 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018959 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018960 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
18961 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
18962 overflowing.
18963
18964 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
18965 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
18966 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
18967 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
18968 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
18969 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
18970 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
18971 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18972
18973 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
18974 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
18975 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
18976 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
18977 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
18978 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
18979 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
18980 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18981
18982 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18983 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18984 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
18985 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
18986 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
18987 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
18988 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
18989
18990 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018991 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018992 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
18993 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
18994 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018995 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018996 system.
18997
18998 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18999 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19000 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19001 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19002 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19003 caused by a denial of service attack.
19004
19005 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19006 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19007 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19008 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19009 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19010 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19011 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19012 denial of service attack.
19013
19014 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19015 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19016 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19017 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19018 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19019 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19020 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19021 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
19022 processed than on other servers.
19023
19024 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19025 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19026 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19027 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19028 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19029 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19030 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19031 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19032 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19033 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19034 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19035 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19036 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19037
19038 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19039 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19040 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19041 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19042 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19043 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019044 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019045 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19046
19047 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19048 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19049 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19050 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19051 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19052 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019053 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019054 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19055 occurs.
19056
19057 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
19058 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
19059 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
19060 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
19061 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
19062 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
19063 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
19064 cookies" below for more details.
19065
19066 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
19067 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
19068 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
19069 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
19070 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
19071 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
19072 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
19073 and cookies" below for more details.
19074
19075 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
19076 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
19077 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
19078 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
19079 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
19080 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
19081 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
19082 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
19083
19084
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200190858.2.4. Custom log format
19086------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019087
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019088The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019089mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019090
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019091HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019092Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
19093separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
19094prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
19095
19096Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
19097variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019098("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019099
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019100If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020019101as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019102less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
19103the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
19104
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020019105Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
19106"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
19107delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
19108preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019109
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019110Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
19111'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
19112https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
19113such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
19114
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019115Flags are :
19116 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019117 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019118 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
19119 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019120
19121 Example:
19122
19123 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
19124 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
19125
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019126 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
19127
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019128At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
19129
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019130 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
19131 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019132
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019133the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019134
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019135 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
19136 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
19137 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019138
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019139and the default TCP format is defined this way :
19140
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019141 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
19142 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019143
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019144Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
19145
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019146 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019147 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019148 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
19149 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
19150 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019151 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
19152 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
19153 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019154 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019155 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
19156 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000019157 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019158 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
19159 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010019160 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020019161 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019162 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019163 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019164 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020019165 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080019166 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019167 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
19168 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
19169 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
19170 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
19171 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019172 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019173 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019174 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019175 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019176 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019177 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
19178 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019179 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19180 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
19181 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019182 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019183 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
19184 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019185 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019186 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19187 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
19188 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020019189 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020019190 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019191 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
19192 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
19193 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
19194 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020019195 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019196 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019197 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019198 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010019199 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019200 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019201 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
19202 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
19203 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019204 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019205 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
19206 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019207 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019208 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
19209 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020019210 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019211 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019212 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019213 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019214
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019215 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019216
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019217
192188.2.5. Error log format
19219-----------------------
19220
19221When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
19222protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
19223By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
19224"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019225will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019226logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
19227
19228The format looks like this :
19229
19230 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
19231 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
19232 Connection error during SSL handshake
19233
19234 Field Format Extract from the example above
19235 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
19236 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
19237 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
19238 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
19239 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
19240
19241These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
19242failures.
19243
19244
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192458.3. Advanced logging options
19246-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019247
19248Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
19249just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
19250options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
19251for more information about their usage.
19252
19253
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192548.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
19255------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019256
19257It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
19258haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
19259commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
19260monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
19261ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
19262
19263 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
19264 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
19265 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
19266 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
19267
19268 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
19269 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
19270 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019271 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019272 such as other load-balancers.
19273
19274 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
19275 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
19276 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
19277
19278
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192798.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
19280----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019281
19282The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
19283what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
19284or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019285"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019286just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
19287log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
19288after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
19289is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
19290with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
19291with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
19292
19293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192948.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
19295------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019296
19297Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
19298for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
19299"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
19300retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
19301raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
19302a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
19303file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
19304you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
19305"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
19306
19307
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
19309--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019310
19311Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
19312multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
19313them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
19314"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
19315logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
19316error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
19317and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
19318too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
19319useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
19320alternative.
19321
19322
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193238.4. Timing events
19324------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019325
19326Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
19327reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
19328the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
19329frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019330mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
19331addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
19332
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019333Timings events in HTTP mode:
19334
19335 first request 2nd request
19336 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
19337 t tr t tr ...
19338 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
19339 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
19340 :<---- Tq ---->: :
19341 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019342 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019343 :<--------- Ta --------->:
19344
19345Timings events in TCP mode:
19346
19347 TCP session
19348 |<----------------->|
19349 t t
19350 ---|----|----|----|----|---
19351 | Th Tw Tc Td |
19352 |<------ Tt ------->|
19353
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019354 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019355 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019356 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
19357 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
19358 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019359 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019360 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
19361 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
19362 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
19363 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019364
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019365 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
19366 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
19367 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019368 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
19369 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
19370 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
19371 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
19372 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
19373 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019374
19375 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
19376 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
19377 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
19378 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
19379 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
19380 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
19381 request typed by hand during a test.
19382
19383 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
19384 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019385 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019386 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
19387 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
19388 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
19389 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019390
19391 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
19392 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
19393 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
19394 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
19395 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
19396
19397 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
19398 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
19399 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
19400 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
19401 connection never established.
19402
19403 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
19404 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
19405 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
19406 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
19407 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
19408 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
19409 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
19410 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
19411 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
19412 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
19413 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
19414
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019415 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
19416 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
19417 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
19418 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
19419 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
19420 by subtracting other timers when valid :
19421
19422 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
19423
19424 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
19425 "Ta" can never be negative.
19426
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019427 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
19428 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019429 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
19430 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019431 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019432
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019433 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019434
19435 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019436 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
19437 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019438
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019439 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
19440 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
19441 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
19442 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
19443 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
19444 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
19445 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
19446 prefixed with a '+' sign.
19447
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019448These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
19449protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
19450that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019451due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
19452"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
19453that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019454
19455Most common cases :
19456
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019457 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
19458 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
19459 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
19460 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
19461 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
19462 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
19463 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
19464 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
19465 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
19466 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
19467 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020019468 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019469
19470 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
19471 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
19472 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
19473 of ms on remote networks.
19474
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019475 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
19476 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
19477 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019478
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019479 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
19480 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
19481 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
19482 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
19483 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
19484 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
19485 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
19486 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
19487 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019488
19489Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
19490
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019491 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019492 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019493 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019494
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019495 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019496 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
19497 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
19498
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019499 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019500 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
19501 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
19502 flags.
19503
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019504 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
19505 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019506 Check the session termination flags, then check the
19507 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
19508 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
19509 the client connection was maintained open.
19510
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019511 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019512 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019513 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019514 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
19515
19516
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200195178.5. Session state at disconnection
19518-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019519
19520TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
19521"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
195222-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
19523each of which has a special meaning :
19524
19525 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
19526 session to terminate :
19527
19528 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
19529
19530 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
19531 server explicitly refused it.
19532
19533 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
19534 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
19535 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
19536 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019537 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019538
19539 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
19540 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019541
19542 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
19543 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
19544 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
19545 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
19546 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
19547
19548 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
19549 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
19550 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
19551 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
19552 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
19553
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090019554 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
19555 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
19556
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070019557 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
19558 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
19559 backup connections when going up.
19560
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020019561 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
19562
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019563 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
19564 send or receive data.
19565
19566 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
19567 send or receive data.
19568
19569 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
19570 with nothing left in the buffers.
19571
19572 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
19573
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010019574 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019575 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
19576
19577 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
19578 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
19579 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
19580 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
19581 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
19582
19583 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
19584 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
19585
19586 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
19587 server (HTTP only).
19588
19589 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
19590
19591 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
19592 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
19593 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
19594
19595 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
19596 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
19597 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
19598
19599 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
19600
19601 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
19602 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
19603
19604 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
19605 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
19606 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
19607
19608 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
19609 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020019610 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
19611 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019612
19613 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
19614 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
19615 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
19616 another server.
19617
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019618 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019619 server.
19620
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019621 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
19622 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
19623 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
19624 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19625
19626 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
19627 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
19628 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
19629 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19630
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020019631 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
19632 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
19633 "use-server" rule).
19634
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019635 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19636
19637 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
19638 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
19639
19640 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
19641
19642 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
19643 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
19644 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
19645
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019646 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
19647 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019648 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019649 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
19650 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
19651
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019652 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
19653
19654 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
19655 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
19656
19657 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
19658
19659 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19660
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019661The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
19662was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019663helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
19664starvation, attacks, etc...
19665
19666The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
19667alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
19668easier finding and understanding.
19669
19670 Flags Reason
19671
19672 -- Normal termination.
19673
19674 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
19675 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
19676 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
19677 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
19678
19679 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
19680 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
19681 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
19682 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
19683 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
19684 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019685
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019686 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19687 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019688 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019689
19690 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
19691 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
19692 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
19693
19694 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
19695 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
19696 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
19697 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
19698 the server takes too long to respond.
19699
19700 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
19701 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
19702 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
19703 long a time to respond.
19704
19705 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
19706 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
19707 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
19708 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019709 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
19710 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019711
19712 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
19713 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
19714 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
19715 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
19716 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020019717 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019718 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
19719 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
19720 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
19721 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
19722 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
19723 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
19724 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
19725 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019726 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019727 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
19728 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
19729 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019730
19731 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
19732 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019733 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
19734 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
19735 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
19736 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019737
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019738 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
19739 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
19740
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019741 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019742 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
19743 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019744 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019745 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
19746 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
19747
19748 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
19749 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
19750 503 or 504 here.
19751
19752 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
19753 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
19754 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
19755 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
19756 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
19757
19758 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19759 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019760 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019761 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
19762 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
19763
19764 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
19765 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
19766 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
19767 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
19768 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
19769 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
19770 between haproxy and the server.
19771
19772 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
19773 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
19774 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
19775 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
19776 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
19777 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
19778 solution is to fix the application.
19779
19780 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
19781 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
19782 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
19783 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
19784 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
19785 external attacks.
19786
19787 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
19788 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019789 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019790 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
19791 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
19792
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019793 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
19794 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
19795 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019796 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020019797 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019798
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019799 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
19800 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
19801 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
19802 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019803 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
19804 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
19805 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
19806 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
19807 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019808
19809 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
19810 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
19811 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
19812 returned an HTTP 403 error.
19813
19814 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
19815 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
19816 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
19817 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
19818
19819 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
19820 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
19821 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
19822 only be solved by proper system tuning.
19823
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019824The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
19825persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
19826important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
19827re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
19828
19829 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
19830
19831 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19832 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
19833 set on a GET request.
19834
19835 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
19836 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019837 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019838 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
19839
19840 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
19841 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
19842 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
19843
19844 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19845 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
19846 already got a cookie.
19847
19848 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19849 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
19850 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
19851 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
19852 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
19853
19854 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19855 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19856 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19857
19858 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
19859 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19860 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19861
19862 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
19863 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
19864
19865 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
19866 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
19867 then advertised in the response.
19868
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019869
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198708.6. Non-printable characters
19871-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019872
19873In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
19874consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
19875converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
19876prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
19877being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
19878escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
19879is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
19880'}' when logging headers.
19881
19882Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
19883issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
19884containing spaces is "User-Agent".
19885
19886Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
19887the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
19888performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
19889
19890
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198918.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
19892---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019893
19894Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
19895achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019896section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019897cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
19898the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
19899the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019900locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019901not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
19902user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
19903a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
19904wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
19905
19906 Examples :
19907 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
19908 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
19909
19910 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
19911 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
19912
19913
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199148.8. Capturing HTTP headers
19915---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019916
19917Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
19918proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
19919the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
19920server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
19921
19922Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
19923response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019924section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019925
19926It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019927time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
19928appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019929are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
19930and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
19931follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
19932request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
19933in the logs.
19934
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019935As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
19936frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
19937an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
19938
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019939 Example :
19940 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
19941 listen proxy-out
19942 mode http
19943 option httplog
19944 option logasap
19945 log global
19946 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
19947
19948 # log the name of the virtual server
19949 capture request header Host len 20
19950
19951 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
19952 capture request header Content-Length len 10
19953
19954 # log the beginning of the referrer
19955 capture request header Referer len 20
19956
19957 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
19958 capture response header Server len 20
19959
19960 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
19961 capture response header Content-Length len 10
19962
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019963 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019964 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
19965
19966 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
19967 capture response header Via len 20
19968
19969 # log the URL location during a redirection
19970 capture response header Location len 20
19971
19972 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
19973 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
19974 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19975 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
19976 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
19977
19978 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19979 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19980 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19981 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019982 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019983
19984 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19985 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19986 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19987 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
19988 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019989 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019990
19991
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199928.9. Examples of logs
19993---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019994
19995These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
19996them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
19997reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
19998
19999 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
20000 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20001 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20002
20003 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
20004 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
20005
20006 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
20007 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
20008 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20009
20010 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
20011 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
20012
20013 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
20014 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20015 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
20016
20017 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020018 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020019 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
20020 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
20021
20022 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
20023 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
20024 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
20025
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020020026 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
20027 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
20028 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
20029 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
20030 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
20031 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020032
20033 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020034 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020035
20036 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
20037 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
20038 Nothing was sent to any server.
20039
20040 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
20041 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
20042
20043 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
20044 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020045 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020046 send a 408 return code to the client.
20047
20048 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
20049 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
20050
20051 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
20052 5 seconds ("c----").
20053
20054 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
20055 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020056 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020057
20058 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020059 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020060 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
20061 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
20062 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
20063 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
20064 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020065
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020020066
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200200679. Supported filters
20068--------------------
20069
20070Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
20071accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
20072unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
20073
20074See also : "filter"
20075
200769.1. Trace
20077----------
20078
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020079filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020080
20081 Arguments:
20082 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
20083 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
20084
20085 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
20086 the client and the server. By default, this filter
20087 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
20088 only parses a random amount of the available data.
20089
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020090 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020091 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
20092 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
20093 amount of the parsed data.
20094
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020095 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020096
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020097This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
20098callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
20099information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
20100filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
20101
20102Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
20103tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
20104a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
20105
20106
201079.2. HTTP compression
20108---------------------
20109
20110filter compression
20111
20112The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
20113keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020114when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
20115fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
20116done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
20117explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
20118filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
20119listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20120order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020121
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020122See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
20123 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020124
20125
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200201269.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
20127--------------------------------------------
20128
20129filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
20130
20131 Arguments :
20132
20133 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
20134 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
20135 parsed.
20136
20137 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
20138 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
20139 part must be placed in its own scope.
20140
20141The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
20142external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020143streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020144exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
20145also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
20146
20147SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
20148the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
20149
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020150For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020151"doc/SPOE.txt".
20152
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100201539.4. Cache
20154----------
20155
20156filter cache <name>
20157
20158 Arguments :
20159
20160 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
20161
20162The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
20163"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020164cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020165other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
20166case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
20167is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
20168filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010020169listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20170order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010020171
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020172See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
20173 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
20174
20175
201769.5. Fcgi-app
20177-------------
20178
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020179filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020180
20181 Arguments :
20182
20183 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
20184
20185The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
20186request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
20187reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
20188used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
20189implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
20190used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
20191fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
20192used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20193order.
20194
20195See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
20196 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
20197
20198
2019910. FastCGI applications
20200-------------------------
20201
20202HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
20203feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
20204the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
20205FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
20206servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
20207FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
20208backend.
20209
20210HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
20211application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
20212connection.
20213
2021410.1. Setup
20215-----------
20216
2021710.1.1. Fcgi-app section
20218--------------------------
20219
20220fcgi-app <name>
20221 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
20222 document root must be defined.
20223
20224acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
20225 Declare or complete an access list.
20226
20227 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
20228 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
20229 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
20230 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
20231 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
20232
20233docroot <path>
20234 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
20235 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
20236 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
20237
20238index <script-name>
20239 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
20240 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
20241 is an optional setting.
20242
20243 Example :
20244 index index.php
20245
20246log-stderr global
20247log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
20248 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
20249 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
20250
20251 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
20252 default STDERR messages are ignored.
20253
20254pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20255 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
20256 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
20257 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20258
20259 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
20260 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
20261 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
20262 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
20263
20264 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
20265 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
20266
20267path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020268 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020269 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
20270 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
20271 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
20272 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
20273 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
20274 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
20275 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020276
20277 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020278 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020279 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
20280 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
20281 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
20282 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020283
20284 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020285 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
20286 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020287
20288option get-values
20289no option get-values
20290 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
20291
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020292 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020293 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
20294
20295 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
20296 application will accept.
20297
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020020298 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
20299 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020300
20301 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050020302 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020303 option is disabled.
20304
20305 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
20306 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
20307 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
20308 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
20309 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
20310 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
20311
20312option keep-conn
20313no option keep-conn
20314 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
20315 sending a response.
20316
20317 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
20318 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
20319
20320option max-reqs <reqs>
20321 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
20322 accept.
20323
20324 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
20325 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
20326 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
20327 to 1.
20328
20329option mpxs-conns
20330no option mpxs-conns
20331 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
20332
20333 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
20334 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
20335
20336set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20337 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
20338 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
20339 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
20340 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20341
20342 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
20343 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
20344 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
20345
20346 Example :
20347 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
20348 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
20349
20350 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
20351
20352
2035310.1.2. Proxy section
20354---------------------
20355
20356use-fcgi-app <name>
20357 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
20358
20359 Arguments :
20360 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
20361
20362 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
20363 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
20364 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
20365 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
20366 application may be defined at a time per backend.
20367
20368 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
20369 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
20370 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
20371 application are evaluated.
20372
20373
2037410.1.3. Example
20375---------------
20376
20377 frontend front-http
20378 mode http
20379 bind *:80
20380 bind *:
20381
20382 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
20383 default_backend back-static
20384
20385 backend back-static
20386 mode http
20387 server www A.B.C.D:80
20388
20389 backend back-dynamic
20390 mode http
20391 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
20392 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
20393
20394 fcgi-app php-fpm
20395 log-stderr global
20396 option keep-conn
20397
20398 docroot /var/www/my-app
20399 index index.php
20400 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
20401
20402
2040310.2. Default parameters
20404------------------------
20405
20406A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
20407the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020408script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020409applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
20410
20411 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20412 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
20413 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
20414 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
20415 | | |
20416 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20417 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
20418 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
20419 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
20420 | | application. |
20421 | | |
20422 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20423 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
20424 | | the request. It may not be set. |
20425 | | |
20426 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20427 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
20428 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
20429 | | the application's configuration. |
20430 | | |
20431 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20432 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
20433 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
20434 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
20435 | | |
20436 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20437 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
20438 | | following the part that identifies the script |
20439 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
20440 | | be defined. |
20441 | | |
20442 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20443 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
20444 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
20445 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
20446 | | is not set too. |
20447 | | |
20448 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20449 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
20450 | | set. |
20451 | | |
20452 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20453 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
20454 | | the request. |
20455 | | |
20456 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20457 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
20458 | | client as part of user authentication. |
20459 | | |
20460 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20461 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
20462 | | script to process the request. |
20463 | | |
20464 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20465 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
20466 | | |
20467 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20468 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
20469 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
20470 | | |
20471 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20472 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
20473 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
20474 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
20475 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
20476 | | |
20477 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20478 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
20479 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
20480 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
20481 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
20482 | | side. |
20483 | | |
20484 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20485 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
20486 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
20487 | | connected to. |
20488 | | |
20489 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20490 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
20491 | | |
20492 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20493 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
20494 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
20495 | | |
20496 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20497
20498
2049910.3. Limitations
20500------------------
20501
20502The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
20503way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
20504during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
20505establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
20506application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
20507or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
20508message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
20509these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
20510and HTTP servers under the same backend.
20511
20512Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
20513request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
20514requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
20515
20516About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
20517into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
20518fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
20519"http-request" ones.
20520
20521Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
20522FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
20523processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
20524must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
20525here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010020526
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020527/*
20528 * Local variables:
20529 * fill-column: 79
20530 * End:
20531 */